The center of each meter (upper and lower) illuminates with reduced ... come out of the holder. Pivot the blade assembly toward the wiper arm until ...
2009 Civic Hybrid Owner's Manual (Unlinked) This document does not contain hyperlinks and may be formatted for printing instead of web use. This is due to changes in content and specifications of the vehicle that happen throughout the model year. This manual will be replaced with a hyperlinked version at the end of the model year. © 2008 Honda Motor Co., Ltd. P/N 00X31-SNC-6300 Owner's Identification OWNER ADDRESS STREET CITY V. I. N. DELIVERY DATE DEALER NAME ADDRESS STATE/PROVINCE ZIP CODE/ POSTAL CODE (Date sold to original retail purchaser) DEALER NO. STREET CITY OWNER'S SIGNATURE DEALER'S SIGNATURE STATE/PROVINCE ZIP CODE/ POSTAL CODE This owner's manual should be considered a permanent part of the vehicle and should remain with the vehicle when it is sold. This owner's manual covers all models of the Civic Hybrid. You may find descriptions of equipment and features that are not on your particular model. The information and specifications included in this publication were in effect at the time of approval for printing. Honda Motor Co., Ltd. reserves the right, however, to discontinue or change specifications or design at any time without notice and without incurring any obligation whatsoever. POUR CLIENTS CANADIEN AVIS IMPORTANT: Si vous avez besoin d'un Manuel du Conducteur en français, veuillez demander à votre concessionnaire de commander le numéro de pièce 33SNCC30 Introduction Congratulations! Your selection of a 2009 Honda Civic Hybrid was a wise investment. It will give you years of driving pleasure. One of the best ways to enhance the enjoyment of your new vehicle is to read this manual. In it, you will learn how to operate its driving controls and convenience items. Afterwards, keep this owner's manual in your vehicle so you can refer to it at any time. Several warranties protect your new vehicle. Read the warranty booklet thoroughly so you understand the coverages and are aware of your rights and responsibilities. Maintaining your vehicle according to the schedules given in this manual helps to keep your driving trouble-free while it preserves your investment. When your vehicle needs maintenance, keep in mind that your dealer's staff is specially trained in servicing the many systems unique to your vehicle. Your dealer is dedicated to your satisfaction and will be pleased to answer any questions and concerns. As you read this manual, you will find information that is preceded by a symbol. This information is intended to help you avoid damage to your vehicle, other property, or the environment. i Introduction California Proposition 65 Warning WARNING: This product contains or emits chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other reproductive harm. Event Data Recorders This vehicle is equipped with one or more devices commonly referred to as event data recorders. These devices record front seat belt use, front passenger seat occupancy, airbag deployment data, and the failure of any airbag system component. This data belongs to the vehicle owner and may not be accessed by anyone else except as legally required or with the permission of the vehicle owner. Service Diagnostic Recorders This vehicle is equipped with service-related devices that record information about powertrain performance. The data can be used to verify emissions law requirements and/or help technicians diagnose and solve service problems. It may also be combined with data from other sources for research purposes, but it remains confidential. ii A Few Words About Safety Your safety, and the safety of others, is very important. And operating this vehicle safely is an important responsibility. To help you make informed decisions about safety, we have provided operating procedures and other information on labels and in this manual. This information alerts you to potential hazards that could hurt you or others. Of course, it is not practical or possible to warn you about all the hazards associated with operating or maintaining your vehicle. You must use your own good judgement. You will find this important safety information in a variety of forms, including: Safety Labels on the vehicle. Safety Messages preceded by a safety alert symbol and one of three signal words: DANGER, WARNING, or CAUTION. These signal words mean: You WILL be KILLED or SERIOUSLY HURT if you don't follow instructions. You CAN be KILLED or SERIOUSLY HURT if you don't follow instructions. You CAN be HURT if you don't follow instructions. Safety Headings such as Important Safety Reminders or Important Safety Precautions. Safety Section such as Driver and Passenger Safety. Instructions how to use this vehicle correctly and safely. This entire book is filled with important safety information please read it carefully. iii Contents Your Vehicle at a Glance (main controls) ................................................................................................ 3 Driver and Passenger Safety (seat belts, SRS, and child protection) ............................................................. 5 Instruments and Controls (indicators, gauges, dashboard, and steering column)........................................... 55 Features (climate control, audio, steering wheel, security, and cruise control ).............................................. 103 Before Driving (fuel, vehicle break-in, and cargo loading) ........................................................................ 253 Driving (engine and transmission operation).......................................................................................... 269 Maintenance (minder, fluid checking, minor services, and vehicle storage).................................................. 287 Taking Care of the Unexpected (flat tire, dead battery, overheating, and fuses) .......................................... 323 Technical Information (vehicle specifications, tires, and emissions controls)............................................... 347 Warranty and Customer Relations (U.S. and Canada only) (warranty and contact information)................... 363 Authorized Manuals (U.S. only) (how to order) ................................................................................... 367 Index ................................................................................................................................................. I Service Information Summary (fluid capacities and tire pressures) ................................................... last page 1 INDEX Overview of Contents Contents A convenient reference to the sections in this manual. Your Vehicle at a Glance A quick reference to the main controls in your vehicle. Driver and Passenger Safety Important information about the proper use and care of your vehicle's seat belts, an overview of the supplemental restraint system, and valuable information on how to protect children with child restraints. Instruments and Controls Explains the purpose of each instrument panel indicator and gauge, and how to use the controls on the dashboard and steering column. Before Driving What gasoline to use, how to breakin your new vehicle, and how to load luggage and other cargo. Driving The proper way to start the engine, shift the transmission, and park. Maintenance The maintenance minder shows you when you need to take your vehicle to the dealer for maintenance service. There is also a list of things to check and instructions on how to check them. Taking Care of the Unexpected This section covers several problems motorists sometimes experience, and details how to handle them. Warranty and Customer Relations (U.S. and Canada only) A summary of the warranties covering your new vehicle, and how to contact us for any reason. Refer to your warranty manual for detailed information. Authorized Manuals (U.S. only) How to order manuals and other technical literature. Index Service Information Summary A summary of the information you need when you pull up to the fuel pump. Features How to operate the climate control system, the audio system, and other convenience features. Technical Information ID numbers, dimensions, capacities, and technical information. 2 Your Vehicle at a Glance Your Vehicle at a Glance INSTRUMENT PANEL INDICATORS (P. 58) GAUGES (P. 64) AUDIO SYSTEM (P. 110) PASSENGER'S FRONT AIRBAG (P. 9, 24) DRIVER'S FRONT AIRBAG (P. 9, 24) MIRROR CONTROLS (P. 98) POWER DOOR LOCK MASTER SWITCH (P. 81) POWER WINDOW SWITCHES (P. 97) FUEL FILL DOOR RELEASE HANDLE (P. 255) TRUNK RELEASE HANDLE (P. 88) AUXILIARY INPUT JACK (P. 167) SEAT HEATER SWITCHES (P. 96) Vehicle with navigation system is shown USB ADAPTER CABLE (P. 142, 185) CLIMATE CONTROL SYSTEM (P. 104) DOOR LOCK TAB (P. 81) ACCESSORY POWER SOCKET (P. 101) AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION (CVT) (P. 272) : If equipped 3 Your Vehicle at a Glance INSTRUMENT PANEL BRIGHTNESS BUTTONS (P. 75) DISPLAY CHANGE BUTTON (P. 65) SEL/RESET BUTTON (P. 65) HEADLIGHTS/TURN SIGNAL (P. 74) HORN1 WINDSHIELD WIPERS/WASHERS (P. 73) PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF INDICATOR (P. 31) VEHICLE STABILITY ASSIST (VSA ) SYSTEM OFF SWITCH2 (P. 286) REMOTE AUDIO CONTROLS (P. 210) BLUETOOTH HANDSFREELINK SYSTEM VOICE CONTROL BUTTONS4 (P. 219) HOOD RELEASE HANDLE (P. 256) NAVIGATION SYSTEM VOICE CONTROL BUTTONS4 (P. 219) Vehicle with navigation system is shown STEERING WHEEL ADJUSTMENT (P. 77) HAZARD WARNING BUTTON (P. 76) REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER (P. 76) HEATED MIRRORS3 (P. 98) CRUISE CONTROL BUTTONS (P. 214) 1 : 2 : 3 : 4 : 4 To use the horn, press the center pad of the steering wheel. If equipped Canadian model only Only on vehicles equipped with navigation system. Refer to the navigation system manual. Driver and Passenger Safety Driver and Passenger Safety This section gives you important information about how to protect yourself and your passengers. It shows you how to use seat belts. It explains how your airbags work. And it tells you how to properly restrain infants and children in your vehicle. Important Safety Precautions .......... 6 Your Vehicle's Safety Features........ 7 Seat Belts ........................................ 8 Airbags............................................ 9 Protecting Adults and Teens.......... 11 1. Close and Lock the Doors ...... 11 2. Adjust the Front Seats ............ 11 3. Adjust the Seat-Backs ............. 12 4. Adjust the Head Restraints .... 13 5. Fasten and Position the Seat Belts.............................. 14 6. Maintain a Proper Sitting Position ................................. 15 Advice for Pregnant Women...... 16 Additional Safety Precautions.... 17 Additional Information About Your Seat Belts ........................ 18 Seat Belt System Components... 18 Lap/Shoulder Belt....................... 19 Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners................................ 19 Seat Belt Maintenance ................ 20 Additional Information About Your Airbags ............................ 21 Airbag System Components....... 21 How Your Front Airbags Work.......................................... 24 How Your Side Airbags Work.... 28 How Your Side Curtain Airbags Work.......................................... 29 How the SRS Indicator Works ... 30 How the Side Airbag Off Indicator Works....................... 30 How the Passenger Airbag Off Indicator Works....................... 31 Airbag Service.............................. 32 Additional Safety Precautions.... 32 Protecting ChildrenGeneral Guidelines................................. 34 All Children Must Be Restrained ................................ 34 All Children Should Sit in a Back Seat .................................. 35 The Passenger's Front Airbag Can Pose Serious Risks .......... 35 If You Must Drive with Several Children .................................... 37 If a Child Requires Close Attention ................................... 37 Additional Safety Precautions.... 38 Protecting Infants and Small Children .................................... 39 Protecting Infants........................ 39 Protecting Small Children .......... 40 Selecting a Child Seat...................... 41 Installing a Child Seat ..................... 42 With LATCH ................................ 43 With a Lap/Shoulder Belt .......... 45 With a Tether............................... 46 Protecting Larger Children ............ 48 Checking Seat Belt Fit ................ 48 Using a Booster Seat ................... 49 When Can a Larger Child Sit in Front.......................................... 50 Additional Safety Precautions.... 51 Carbon Monoxide Hazard .............. 52 Safety Labels .................................... 53 5 Important Safety Precautions You'll find many safety recommendations throughout this section, and throughout this manual. The recommendations on this page are the ones we consider to be the most important. Always Wear Your Seat Belt A seat belt is your best protection in all types of collisions. Airbags are designed to supplement seat belts, not replace them. So even though your vehicle is equipped with airbags, make sure you and your passengers always wear your seat belts, and wear them properly (see page 14 ). Restrain All Children Children age 12 and under should ride properly restrained in a back seat, not the front seat. Infants and small children should be restrained in a child seat. Larger children should use a booster seat and a lap/ shoulder belt until they can use the belt properly without a booster seat (see pages 34 51 ). Be Aware of Airbag Hazards While airbags can save lives, they can cause serious or fatal injuries to occupants who sit too close to them, or are not properly restrained. Infants, young children, and short adults are at the greatest risk. Be sure to follow all instructions and warnings in this manual. Don't Drink and Drive Alcohol and driving don't mix. Even one drink can reduce your ability to respond to changing conditions, and your reaction time gets worse with every additional drink. So don't drink and drive, and don't let your friends drink and drive, either. Control Your Speed Excessive speed is a major factor in crash injuries and deaths. Generally, the higher the speed, the greater the risk, but serious injuries can also occur at lower speeds. Never drive faster than is safe for current conditions, regardless of the maximum speed posted. Keep Your Vehicle in Safe Condition Having a tire blowout or a mechanical failure can be extremely hazardous. To reduce the possibility of such problems, check your tire pressures and condition frequently, and perform all regularly scheduled maintenance (see page 289 ). 6 Driver and Passenger Safety Your Vehicle's Safety Features (9) (3) (9) (1) (4) (8) (7) (11) (2) (5) (10) (12) (6) (8) (2) (1) Safety Cage (2) Crush Zone (3) Seats and Seat-Backs (4) Head Restraints (5) Collapsible Steering Column (6) Seat Belts (7) Front Airbags (8) Side Airbags (9) Side Curtain Airbags (10) Front Seat Belt Tensioners (11) Door Locks (12) Front Seat Belt Buckle Tensioners Your vehicle is equipped with many features that work together to protect you and your passengers during a crash. Some features do not require any action on your part. These include a strong steel framework that forms a safety cage around the passenger compartment, front and rear crush zones, a collapsible steering column, and tensioners that tighten the front seat belts in a crash. However, you and your passengers can't take full advantage of these features unless you remain sitting in a proper position and always wear your seat belts. In fact, some safety features can contribute to injuries if they are not used properly. The following pages explain how you can take an active role in protecting yourself and your passengers. 7 Your Vehicle's Safety Features Seat Belts Your vehicle is equipped with seat belts in all seating positions. Your seat belt system also includes an indicator on the instrument panel and a beeper to remind you and your passengers to fasten your seat belts. Why Wear Seat Belts Seat belts are the single most effective safety device for adults and larger children. (Infants and smaller children must be properly restrained in child seats.) Not wearing a seat belt properly increases the chance of serious injury or death in a crash, even though your vehicle has airbags. In addition, most states and all Canadian provinces require you to wear seat belts. Not wearing a seat belt properly increases the chance of serious injury or death in a crash, even though your vehicle has airbags. Be sure you and your passengers always wear seat belts and wear them properly. When properly worn, seat belts: Keep you connected to the vehicle so you can take advantage of the vehicle's built-in safety features. Help protect you in almost every type of crash, including: frontal impacts side impacts rear impacts rollovers Help keep you from being thrown against the inside of the vehicle and against other occupants. Keep you from being thrown out of the vehicle. Help keep you in a good position should the airbags ever deploy. A good position reduces the risk of injury from an inflating airbag and allows you to get the best advantage from the airbag. Of course, seat belts cannot completely protect you in every crash. But in most cases, seat belts can reduce your risk of serious injury. What You Should Do: Always wear your seat belt, and make sure you wear it properly. 8 Airbags Your Vehicle's Safety Features Driver and Passenger Safety Your vehicle has a supplemental restraint system (SRS) with front airbags to help protect the heads and chests of the driver and a front seat passenger during a moderate to severe frontal collision (see page 24 for more information on how your front airbags work). Your vehicle also has side airbags to help protect the upper torso of the driver or a front seat passenger during a moderate to severe side impact (see page 28 for more information on how your side airbags work). In addition, your vehicle has side curtain airbags to help protect the heads of the driver, front passenger, and passengers in the outer rear seating positions during a moderate to severe side impact (see page 29 for more information on how your side curtain airbags work). CONTINUED 9 Your Vehicle's Safety Features The most important things you need to know about your airbags are: Airbags do not replace seat belts. They are designed to supplement the seat belts. Airbags offer no protection in rear impacts, or minor frontal or side collisions. Airbags can pose hazards. To do their job, airbags must inflate with tremendous force. So while airbags help save lives, they can cause minor injuries or more serious or even fatal injuries if occupants are not properly restrained or sitting properly. What you should do: Always wear your seat belt properly, and sit upright and as far back from the steering wheel as possible while allowing full control of the vehicle. A front passenger should move their seat as far back from the dashboard as possible. The rest of this section gives more detailed information about how you can maximize your safety. Remember, however, that no safety system can prevent all injuries or deaths that can occur in a severe crash, even when seat belts are properly worn and the airbags deploy. 10 Driver and Passenger Safety Protecting Adults and Teens Introduction The following pages provide instructions on how to properly protect the driver, adult passengers and teenage children who are large enough and mature enough to drive or ride in the front seat. See pages 34 51 for important guidelines on how to properly protect infants, small children, and larger children who ride in your vehicle. 1.Close and Lock the Doors After everyone has entered the vehicle, be sure the doors are closed and locked. 2.Adjust the Front Seats Your vehicle has a door-open indicator on the instrument panel to indicate when any door is not tightly closed. Locking the doors reduces the chance of someone being thrown out of the vehicle during a crash, and it helps prevent passengers from accidentally opening a door and falling out. Locking the doors also helps prevent an outsider from unexpectedly opening a door when you come to a stop. See page 81 for how to lock the doors, page 60 for how the door-open indicator works, and page 82 for how the automatic door locking and unlocking feature works. Adjust the driver's seat as far to the rear as possible while allowing you to maintain full control of the vehicle. Have a front passenger adjust their seat as far to the rear as possible. CONTINUED 11 Protecting Adults and Teens If you sit too close to the steering wheel or dashboard, you can be seriously injured by an inflating front airbag, or by striking the steering wheel or dashboard. The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration and Transport Canada recommend that drivers allow at least 10 inches (25 cm) between the center of the steering wheel and the chest. In addition to adjusting the seat, you can adjust the steering wheel up and down, and in and out (see page 77 ). If you cannot get far enough away from the steering wheel and still reach the controls, we recommend that you investigate whether some type of adaptive equipment may help. Sitting too close to a front airbag can result in serious injury or death if the front airbags inflate. Always sit as far back from the front airbags as possible. Once a seat is adjusted correctly, rock it back and forth to make sure it is locked in position. See page 91 for how to adjust the front seats. 3.Adjust the Seat-Backs Adjust the driver's seat-back to a comfortable, upright position, leaving ample space between your chest and the airbag cover in the center of the steering wheel. Passengers with adjustable seatbacks should also adjust their seatback to a comfortable, upright position. 12 Driver and Passenger Safety Protecting Adults and Teens Reclining the seat-back too far can result in serious injury or death in a crash. Adjust the seat-back to an upright position, and sit well back in the seat. Reclining a seat-back so that the shoulder part of the belt no longer rests against the occupant's chest reduces the protective capability of the belt. It also increases the chance of sliding under the belt in a crash and being seriously injured. The farther a seat-back is reclined, the greater the risk of injury. See page 92 for how to adjust the seat-backs. 4.Adjust the Head Restraints Adjust the driver's head restraint so the center of the back of your head rests against the center of the restraint. Have passengers adjust their head restraints properly as well. Taller persons should adjust their restraint as high as possible. Improperly positioning head restraints reduces their effectiveness, and you can be seriously injured in a crash. Make sure head restraints are in place and positioned properly before driving. Properly adjusted head restraints will help protect occupants from whiplash and other crash injuries. See page 92 for how to adjust the head restraints and how the driver's and front passenger's active head restraints work. 13 Protecting Adults and Teens 5.Fasten and Position the Seat Belts Insert the latch plate into the buckle, then tug on the belt to make sure the belt is securely latched. Check that the belt is not twisted, because a twisted belt can cause serious injuries in a crash. Improperly positioning the seat belts can cause serious injury or death in a crash. Make sure all seat belts are properly positioned before driving. Position the lap part of the belt as low as possible across your hips, then pull up on the shoulder part of the belt so the lap part fits snugly. This lets your strong pelvic bones take the force of a crash and reduces the chance of internal injuries. If the seat belt touches or crosses your neck, or if it crosses your arm instead of your shoulder, you need to adjust the seat belt anchor height. If necessary, pull up on the belt again to remove any slack, then check that the belt rests across the center of your chest and over your shoulder. This spreads the forces of a crash over the strongest bones in your upper body. 14 Driver and Passenger Safety Protecting Adults and Teens RELEASE BUTTON The front seats have adjustable seat belt anchors. To adjust the height of an anchor, press and hold the release button and slide the anchor up or down as needed (it has four positions). Never place the shoulder portion of a lap/shoulder belt under your arm or behind your back. This could cause very serious injuries in a crash. If a seat belt does not seem to work properly, it may not protect the occupant in a crash. No one should sit in a seat with an inoperative seat belt. Using a seat belt that is not working properly can result in serious injury or death. Have your dealer check the belt as soon as possible. See page 18 for additional information about your seat belts and how to take care of them. 6.Maintain a Proper Sitting Position After all occupants have adjusted their seats and head restraints, and put on their seat belts, it is very important that they continue to sit upright, well back in their seats, with their feet on the floor, until the vehicle is parked and the engine is off. Sitting improperly can increase the chance of injury during a crash. For example, if an occupant slouches, lies down, turns sideways, sits forward, leans forward or sideways, or puts one or both feet up, the chance of injury during a crash is greatly increased. CONTINUED 15 Protecting Adults and Teens In addition, an occupant who is out of position in the front seat can be seriously or fatally injured in a crash by striking interior parts of the vehicle or being struck by an inflating front airbag. Advice for Pregnant Women Sitting improperly or out of position can result in serious injury or death in a crash. Always sit upright, well back in the seat, with your feet on the floor. If you are pregnant, the best way to protect yourself and your unborn child when driving or riding in a vehicle is to always wear a seat belt, and keep the lap part of the belt as low as possible across the hips. When driving, remember to sit upright and adjust the seat as far back as possible while allowing full control of the vehicle. When riding as a front passenger, adjust the seat as far back as possible. This will reduce the risk of injuries to both you and your unborn child that can be caused by a crash or an inflating front airbag. Each time you have a checkup, ask your doctor if it's okay for you to drive. 16 Driver and Passenger Safety Protecting Adults and Teens Additional Safety Precautions Two people should never use the same seat belt. If they do, they could be very seriously injured in a crash. Do not put any accessories on seat belts. Devices intended to improve occupant comfort or reposition the shoulder part of a seat belt can reduce the protective capability of the seat belt and increase the chance of serious injury in a crash. Do not place hard or sharp objects between yourself and a front airbag. Carrying hard or sharp objects on your lap, or driving with a pipe or other sharp object in your mouth, can result in injuries if your front airbag inflates. Do not attach or place objects on the front airbag covers. Objects on the covers marked ``SRS AIRBAG'' could interfere with the proper operation of the airbags or be propelled inside the vehicle and hurt someone if the airbags inflate. Keep your hands and arms away from the airbag covers. If your hands or arms are close to an airbag cover, they could be injured if the airbag inflates. Do not attach hard objects on or near a door. If a side airbag or a side curtain airbag inflates, a cup holder or other hard object attached on or near the door could be propelled inside the vehicle and hurt someone. 17 Additional Information About Your Seat Belts Seat Belt System Components Your seat belt system includes lap/ shoulder belts in all seating positions. The front seat belts are also equipped with automatic seat belt tensioners. This system uses the same sensors as the front airbags to monitor whether the front seat belts are latched or unlatched, and how much weight is on the front passenger's seat (see pages 26 and 27 ). Seat Belt Indicator your seat belt is not fastened before the beeper stops, the indicator will stop flashing but remain on. If a front passenger does not fasten their seat belt, the indicator will come on about 6 seconds after the ignition switch is turned to the ON (II) position. If either the driver or a front passenger does not fasten their seat belt while driving, the beeper will sound and the indicator will flash again at regular intervals. The seat belt system includes an indicator on the instrument panel and a beeper to remind you and your passengers to fasten your seat belts. This system monitors the front seat belts. If you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position before your seat belt is fastened, the beeper will sound and the indicator will flash. If When no one is sitting in the front passenger's seat, or a child or small adult is riding there, the indicator should not come on and the beeper should not sound. If the indicator comes on or the beeper sounds when the driver's seat belt is latched and there is no front seat passenger and no items on the front seat, something may be interfering with the monitoring system. Look for and remove: Any items under the front passenger's seat. Any object(s) hanging on the seat or in the seat-back pocket. Any object on the floor that is touching the rear of the seat-back. If no obstructions are found, have your vehicle checked by a dealer. 18 Driver and Passenger Safety Additional Information About Your Seat Belts Lap/Shoulder Belt The lap/shoulder belt goes over your shoulder, across your chest, and across your hips. To fasten the belt, insert the latch plate into the buckle, then tug on the belt to make sure the buckle is latched (see page 14 for how to properly position the belt). To unlock the belt, press the red PRESS button on the buckle. Guide the belt across your body so that it retracts completely. After exiting the vehicle, be sure the belt is out of the way and will not get closed in the door. restrain your body. The seat belts in all positions except the driver's have a lockable retractor that must be activated to secure a child seat (see page 45 ). If the shoulder part of the belt is pulled all the way out, the lockable retractor will activate. The belt will retract, but it will not allow the passenger to move freely. To deactivate the lockable retractor, unlatch the buckle and let the seat belt fully retract. To refasten the seat belt, pull it out only as far as needed. All seat belts have an emergency locking retractor. In normal driving, the retractor lets you move freely in your seat while it keeps some tension on the belt. During a collision or sudden stop, the retractor automatically locks the belt to help Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners For added protection, the front seat belts are equipped with automatic seat belt tensioners. When activated, the tensioners immediately tighten the belts to help hold the driver and a front passenger in position. The tensioners are designed to activate in any collision severe enough to cause the front airbags to deploy. CONTINUED 19 Additional Information About Your Seat Belts If a side curtain airbag deploys during a side impact, the tensioner on that side of the vehicle will also activate. The tensioners can also be activated during a collision in which the front airbags do not deploy. In this case, the airbags would not be needed, but the additional restraint could be helpful. When the tensioners are activated, the seat belts will remain tight until they are unbuckled. Seat Belt Maintenance For safety, you should check the condition of your seat belts regularly. Pull each belt out fully, and look for frays, cuts, burns, and wear. Check that the latches work smoothly and the belts retract easily. If a belt does not retract easily, cleaning the belt may correct the problem (see page 311 ). Any belt that is not in good condition or working properly will not provide good protection and should be replaced as soon as possible. Honda provides a limited warranty on seat belts. See your Honda Warranty Information booklet for details. If a seat belt is worn during a crash, it must be replaced by your dealer. A belt that has been worn during a crash may not provide the same level of protection in a subsequent crash. The dealer should also inspect the anchors for damage and replace them if needed. If the automatic seat belt tensioners activate during a crash, they must be replaced. Not checking or maintaining seat belts can result in serious injury or death if the seat belts do not work properly when needed. Check your seat belts regularly and have any problem corrected as soon as possible. 20 Airbag System Components Additional Information About Your Airbags (8) (1) (9) (2) (3) (12) (11) (5) Driver and Passenger Safety (1) Driver's Front Airbag (2) Passenger's Front Airbag (3) Control Unit (4) Front Seat Belt Tensioners (5) Side Airbags (6) Driver's Seat Position Sensor (7) Front Passenger's Weight Sensors (6) (8) Front Impact Sensors (9) Passenger Airbag Off Indicator (10) Side Impact Sensors (First) (11) Occupant Position Detection System (OPDS) Sensors (12) Front Passenger's Weight Sensors/OPDS Sensors Control Unit (13) Seat Belt Buckle Tensioners (14) Rear Safing Sensor (10) (4) (7) (13) (10) (5) (14) (4) CONTINUED 21 Additional Information About Your Airbags (16) (15) (15) Side Impact Sensor (Second) (16) Side Curtain Airbags 22 (15) Your Airbag System includes: Two SRS (supplemental restraint system) front airbags. The driver's airbag is stored in the center of the steering wheel; the front passenger's airbag is stored in the dashboard. Both are marked ``SRS AIRBAG'' (see page 24 ). Two side airbags, one for the driver and one for a front passenger. The airbags are stored in the outer edges of the seatbacks. Both are marked ``SIDE AIRBAG'' (see page 28 ). Two side curtain airbags, one for each side of the vehicle. The airbags are stored in the ceiling, above the side windows. The front and rear pillars are marked ``SIDE CURTAIN AIRBAG'' (see page 29 ). Driver and Passenger Safety Additional Information About Your Airbags Automatic front seat belt tensioners (see page 19 ). Sensors that can detect a moderate to severe front impact or side impact. Sensors that can detect whether a child is in the passenger's side airbag path and signal the control unit to turn the airbag off (see page 31 ). Sensors that can detect whether the driver's seat belt and the front passenger's seat belt are latched or unlatched (see page 18 ). A driver's seat position sensor that monitors the distance of the seat from the front airbag. If the seat is too far forward, the airbag will inflate with less force (see page 26 ). Weight sensors that monitor the weight on the front passenger's seat. If the weight is about 65 lbs (29 kg) or less (the weight of an infant or small child), the passenger's front airbag will be turned off (see page 26 ). A sophisticated electronic system that continually monitors and records information about the sensors, the control unit, the airbag activators, the seat belt tensioners, and driver and front passenger seat belt use when the ignition switch is in the ON (II) position. An indicator on the instrument panel that alerts you to a possible problem with your airbags, sensors, or seat belt tensioners (see page 30 ). An indicator on the instrument panel that alerts you that the passenger's side airbag has been turned off (see page 30 ). An indicator on the dashboard that alerts you that the passenger's front airbag has been turned off (see page 31 ). Emergency backup power in case your vehicle's electrical system is disconnected in a crash. 23 Additional Information About Your Airbags How Your Front Airbags Work If you ever have a moderate to severe frontal collision, sensors will detect the vehicle's rapid deceleration. If the rate of deceleration is high enough, the control unit will instantly inflate the driver's and front passenger's airbags, at the time and with the force needed. During a frontal crash, your seat belt restrains your lower body and torso, and the front airbag helps protect your head and chest. Although both airbags normally inflate within a split second of each other, it is possible for only one airbag to deploy. This can happen if the severity of a collision is at the margin, or threshold, that determines whether or not the airbags will deploy. In such cases, the seat belt will provide sufficient protection, and the supplemental protection offered by the airbag would be minimal. Only the driver's airbag will deploy if there is no passenger in the front seat, or if the advanced airbag system has turned the passenger's airbag off (see page 31 ). After inflating, the front airbags immediately deflate, so they won't interfere with the driver's visibility, or the ability to steer or operate other controls. The total time for inflation and deflation is one-tenth of a second, so fast that most occupants are not aware that the airbags deployed until they see them lying in their laps. 24 Driver and Passenger Safety Additional Information About Your Airbags After a crash, you may see what looks like smoke. This is actually powder from the airbag's surface. Although the powder is not harmful, people with respiratory problems may experience some temporary discomfort. If this occurs, get out of the vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so. Dual-Stage Airbags Your front airbags are dual-stage airbags. This means they have two inflation stages that can be ignited sequentially or simultaneously, depending on crash severity. In a more severe crash, both stages will ignite simultaneously to provide the quickest and greatest protection. In a less severe crash, one stage will ignite first, then the second stage will ignite a split second later. This provides longer airbag inflation time with a little less force. Dual-Threshold Airbags Your front airbags are also dualthreshold airbags. Airbags with this feature have two deployment thresholds that depend on whether sensors detect the occupant is wearing a seat belt or not. If the occupant's belt is not latched, the airbag will deploy at a slightly lower threshold, because the occupant would need extra protection. If the occupant's belt is latched, the airbag will inflate at a slightly higher threshold, when the airbag would be needed to supplement the protection provided by the seat belt. CONTINUED 25 Additional Information About Your Airbags Advanced Airbags Your front airbags are also advanced airbags. The main purpose of this feature is to help prevent airbagcaused injuries to short drivers and children who ride in front. For both advanced airbags to work properly: Occupants must sit upright and wear their seat belts properly. DRIVER'S SEAT POSITION SENSOR Do not spill any liquids on or under the seats, cover the sensors, or put any objects or metal items under the front seats. Back-seat passengers should not put their feet under the front seats. Failure to follow these instructions could damage the sensors or prevent them from working properly. The driver's advanced front airbag system includes a seat position sensor under the seat. If the seat is too far forward, the airbag will inflate with less force, regardless of the severity of the impact. If there is a problem with the sensor, the SRS indicator will come on, and the airbag will inflate in the normal manner regardless of the driver's seating position. PASSENGER'S SEAT WEIGHT SENSORS The passenger's advanced front airbag system has weight sensors under the seat. Although Honda does not encourage carrying an infant or small child in front, if the sensors detect the weight of an infant or small child (up to about 65 lbs or 29 kg), the system will automatically turn the passenger's front airbag off. Be aware that objects placed on the passenger's seat can also cause the airbag to be turned off. 26 Driver and Passenger Safety Additional Information About Your Airbags When the airbag is turned off, a ``passenger airbag off'' indicator in the center of the dashboard comes on (see page 31 ). If the weight sensors detect there is no passenger in the front seat, the airbag will be off. However, the passenger airbag off indicator will not come on. To ensure that the passenger's advanced front airbag system will work properly, do not do anything that would increase or decrease the weight on the front passenger's seat. This includes: A rear passenger pushing or pulling on the back of the front passenger's seat. Moving the front seat forcibly back against cargo on the seat or floor behind it. Hanging heavy items on the front passenger seat, or placing heavy items in the seat-back pocket. Also, make sure the floor mat behind the front passenger's seat is hooked to the floor mat anchor (see page 311 ). If it is not, the mat may interfere with the proper operation of the sensors and operation of the seat. 27 Additional Information About Your Airbags How Your Side Airbags Work Only one airbag will deploy during a side impact. If the impact is on the passenger's side, the passenger's side airbag will deploy even if there is no passenger. To get the best protection from the side airbags, front seat occupants should wear their seat belts and sit upright and well back in their seats. If you ever have a moderate to severe side impact, sensors will detect rapid acceleration and signal the control unit to instantly inflate either the driver's or the passenger's side airbag. Side Airbag Cutoff System Your vehicle has a side airbag cutoff system designed primarily to protect a child riding in the front passenger's seat. Although Honda does not encourage children to ride in front, if the position sensors detect a child has leaned into the side airbag's deployment path, the airbag will shut off. The side airbag may also shut off if a short adult leans sideways, or a larger adult slouches and leans sideways into the airbag's deployment path. Objects placed on the front passenger seat can also cause the side airbag to be shut off. 28 Driver and Passenger Safety Additional Information About Your Airbags If the side airbag off indicator comes on (see page 30 ), have the passenger sit upright. Once the passenger is out of the airbag's deployment path, the system will turn the airbag back on, and the indicator will go out. There will be some delay between the moment the passenger moves into or out of the airbag deployment path and when the indicator comes on or goes off. A front seat passenger should not use a cushion or other object as a backrest. It may prevent the cutoff system from working properly. How Your Side Curtain Airbags Work SIDE CURTAIN AIRBAG In a moderate to severe side impact, sensors will detect rapid acceleration and signal the control unit to instantly inflate the side curtain airbag and activate the seat belt tensioner on the driver's or the passenger's side of the vehicle. If the impact is on the passenger's side, the passenger's side curtain airbag will inflate even if there are no occupants on that side of the vehicle. To get the best protection from the side curtain airbags, occupants should wear their seat belts and sit upright and well back in their seats. 29 Additional Information About Your Airbags How the SRS Indicator Works The SRS indicator alerts you to a potential problem with your airbags or seat belt tensioners. When you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position, this indicator comes on for several seconds then goes off. This tells you the system is working properly. Ignoring the SRS indicator can result in serious injury or death if the airbag systems or tensioners do not work properly. Have your vehicle checked by a dealer as soon as possible if the SRS indicator alerts you to a possible problem. If the indicator comes on at any other time, or does not come on at all, you should have the system checked by your dealer. For example: If the SRS indicator does not come on after you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. If you see any of these indications, the airbags and seat belt tensioners may not work properly when you need them. If the indicator stays on after the engine starts. If the indicator comes on or flashes on and off while you drive. 30 U.S. Canada How the Side Airbag Off Indicator Works This indicator alerts you that the passenger's side airbag has been automatically shut off. It does not mean there is a problem with your side airbags. When you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position, the indicator should come on for several seconds and then go off (see page 59 ). If it doesn't come on, stays on, or comes on while driving without a passenger in the front seat, have the system checked. Driver and Passenger Safety Additional Information About Your Airbags How the Passenger Airbag Off Indicator Works U.S. Canada PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF INDICATOR This indicator alerts you that the passenger's front airbag has been shut off because weight sensors detect about 65 lbs (29 kg) or less (the weight of an infant or small child) on the front passenger's seat. It does not mean there is a problem with the airbag. Be aware that objects placed on the front seat can cause the indicator to come on. If no weight is detected on the front seat, the airbag will be automatically shut off. However, the indicator will not come on. The passenger airbag off indicator may come on and off repeatedly if the total weight on the seat is near the airbag cutoff threshold. If an adult or teenage passenger is riding in front, move the seat as far to the rear as possible, and have the passenger sit upright and wear the seat belt properly. If the indicator comes on with no front seat passenger and no objects on the seat, or with an adult riding there, something may be interfering with the weight sensors. Look for and remove: Any items under the front passenger's seat. Any object(s) hanging on the seat or in the seat-back pocket. Any object on the floor that is touching the rear of the seat-back. If no obstructions are found, have your vehicle checked by a dealer as soon as possible. 31 Additional Information About Your Airbags Airbag Service Your airbag systems are virtually maintenance free, and there are no parts you can safely service. However, you must have your vehicle serviced if: An airbag ever inflates. Any airbag that has deployed must be replaced along with the control unit and other related parts. Any seat belt tensioner that activates must also be replaced. Do not try to remove or replace any airbag by yourself. This must be done by an authorized dealer or a knowledgeable body shop. The SRS indicator alerts you to a problem. Take your vehicle to an authorized dealer as soon as possible. If you ignore this indication, your airbags may not operate properly. If your vehicle has a moderate to severe impact. Even if your airbags do not inflate, your dealer should inspect the driver's seat position sensor, the front passenger's weight sensors, the front seat belt tensioners, and all seat belts and their anchors worn during a crash to make sure they are operating properly. Additional Safety Precautions Do not attempt to deactivate your airbags. Together, airbags and seat belts provide the best protection. Do not tamper with airbag components or wiring for any reason. Tampering could cause the airbags to deploy, possibly causing very serious injury. 32 Additional Information About Your Airbags Do not remove or modify a front seat without consulting your dealer. This could make the driver's seat position sensor or the front passenger's weight sensors ineffective. If it is necessary to remove or modify a front seat to accommodate a person with disabilities, first contact Honda Automobile Customer Service at (800) 999-1009. Do not cover or replace front seat- back covers without consulting your dealer. Improperly replacing or covering front seat-back covers can prevent your side airbags from inflating during a side impact. Do not expose the front passenger's seat-back to liquid. If water or another liquid soaks into a seatback, it can prevent the side airbag cutoff system from working properly. Driver and Passenger Safety 33 Protecting Children General Guidelines Children depend on adults to protect them. However, despite their best intentions, many adults do not know how to properly protect child passengers. If you have children, or ever need to drive with a child in your vehicle, be sure to read this section. It begins with important general guidelines, then presents special information for infants, small children, and larger children. All Children Must Be Restrained Each year, many children are injured or killed in vehicle crashes because they are either unrestrained or not properly restrained. In fact, vehicle accidents are the number one cause of the death of children age 12 and under. To reduce the number of child deaths and injuries, every state and Canadian province requires that infants and children be properly restrained when they ride in a vehicle. Infants and small children must be restrained in an approved child seat that is properly secured to the vehicle (see pages 39 47 ). Children who are unrestrained or improperly restrained can be seriously injured or killed in a crash. Any child too small for a seat belt should be properly restrained in a child seat. A larger child should be properly restrained with a seat belt and use a booster seat if necessary. Larger children must be restrained with a lap/shoulder belt and ride on a booster seat until the seat belt fits them properly (see pages 48 51 ). 34 Driver and Passenger Safety Protecting Children General Guidelines All Children Should Sit in a Back Seat According to accident statistics, children of all ages and sizes are safer when they are restrained in a back seat. The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration and Transport Canada recommend that all children aged 12 and under be properly restrained in a back seat. Some states have laws restricting where children may ride. Children who ride in back are less likely to be injured by striking interior vehicle parts during a collision or hard braking. Also, children cannot be injured by an inflating front airbag when they ride in the back. The Passenger's Front Airbag Can Pose Serious Risks Front airbags have been designed to help protect adults in a moderate to severe frontal collision. To do this, the passenger's front airbag is quite large, and it can inflate with enough force to cause very serious injuries. Even though your vehicle has an advanced front airbag system that automatically turns the passenger's front airbag off (see page 31 ), please follow these guidelines: Inf ants Never put a rear-facing child seat in the front seat of a vehicle equipped with a passenger's front airbag. If the airbag inflates, it can hit the back of the child seat with enough force to kill or very seriously injure an infant. Small Children Placing a forward-facing child seat in the front seat of a vehicle equipped with a passenger's front airbag can be hazardous. If the vehicle seat is too far forward, or the child's head is thrown forward during a collision, an inflating front airbag can strike the child with enough force to kill or very seriously injure a small child. Larger Children Children who have outgrown child seats are also at risk of being injured or killed by an inflating passenger's front airbag. Whenever possible, larger children should sit in the back seat, on a booster seat if needed, and be properly restrained with a seat belt. (See page 48 for important information about protecting larger children.) CONTINUED 35 Protecting Children General Guidelines To remind you of the passenger's front airbag hazards, and that children must be properly restrained in a back seat, your vehicle has warning labels on the dashboard (U.S. models) and on the front visors. Please read and follow the instructions on these labels. U.S. Models SUN VISORS Canadian Models SUN VISORS DASHBOARD 36 Driver and Passenger Safety Protecting Children General Guidelines If You Must Drive with Several Children Your vehicle has a back seat where children can be properly restrained. If you ever have to carry a group of children, and a child must ride in front: If a Child Requires Close Attention Many parents say they prefer to put an infant or a small child in the front passenger seat so they can watch the child, or because the child requires attention. If a child requires close physical attention or frequent visual contact, we strongly recommend that another adult ride with the child in the back seat. The back seat is far safer for a child than the front. Place the largest child in the front seat, provided the child is large enough to wear the lap/shoulder belt properly (see page 48 ). Move the vehicle seat as far to the rear as possible (see page 91 ). Placing a child in the front seat exposes the child to hazards in a frontal collision, and paying close attention to a child distracts the driver from the important tasks of driving, placing both of you at risk. Have the child sit upright and well back in the seat (see page 15 ). Make sure the seat belt is properly positioned and secured (see page 14 ). 37 Protecting Children General Guidelines Additional Safety Precautions Never hold an infant or child on your lap. If you are not wearing a seat belt in a crash, you could be thrown forward and crush the child against the dashboard or a seat-back. If you are wearing a seat belt, the child can be torn from your arms and be seriously hurt or killed. Never put a seat belt over yourself and a child. During a crash, the belt could press deep into the child and cause serious or fatal injuries. Never let two children use the same seat belt. If they do, they could be very seriously injured in a crash. Use the childproof door locks to prevent children from opening the rear doors. This can prevent children from accidentally falling out (see page 82 ). 38 Make sure any unused seat belt that a child can reach is buckled, the lockable retractor is activated, and the belt is fully retracted and locked. If a child wraps a loose seat belt around their neck, they can be seriously or fatally injured. (See pages 45 and 46 for how to activate and deactivate the lockable retractor.) Do not leave children alone in a vehicle. Leaving children without adult supervision is illegal in most states and Canadian provinces, and can be very hazardous. For example, infants and small children left in a vehicle on a hot day can die from heatstroke. A child left alone with the key in the ignition switch can accidentally set the vehicle in motion, possibly injuring themselves or others. Lock all doors and the trunk when your vehicle is not in use. Children who play in vehicles can accidentally get trapped inside. Teach your children not to play in or around vehicles. Know how to operate the emergency trunk opener and decide if your children should be shown how to use this feature (see page 81 ). Keep vehicle keys and remote transmitters out of the reach of children. Even very young children learn how to unlock vehicle doors, turn on the ignition switch, and open the trunk, which can lead to accidental injury or death. Driver and Passenger Safety Protecting Infants and Small Children Protecting Infants Child Seat Type An infant must be properly restrained in a rear-facing, reclining child seat until the child reaches the seat maker's weight or height limit for the seat, and the child is at least one year old. Only a rear-facing child seat provides proper support for a baby's head, neck, and back. Two types of seats may be used: a seat designed exclusively for infants, or a convertible seat used in the rearfacing, reclining mode. Do not put a rear-facing child seat in a forward-facing position. If placed facing forward, an infant could be very seriously injured during a frontal collision. Rear-facing Child Seat Placement A rear-facing child seat can be placed in any seating position in the back seat, but not in the front. Never put a rear-facing child seat in the front seat. If the passenger's front airbag inflates, it can hit the back of the child seat with enough force to kill or seriously injure an infant. When properly installed, a rearfacing child seat may prevent the driver or a front passenger from moving their seat as far back as recommended, or from locking their seat-back in the desired position. It could also interfere with proper operation of the passenger's advanced front airbag system. CONTINUED 39 Protecting Infants and Small Children In any of these situations, we strongly recommend that you install the child seat directly behind the front passenger's seat, move the seat as far forward as needed, and leave it unoccupied. Or, you may wish to get a smaller rear-facing child seat. Protecting Small Children Placing a rear-facing child seat in the front seat can result in serious injury or death during a collision. Always place a rear-facing child seat in the back seat, not the front. Child Seat Type A child who is at least one year old, and who fits within the child seat maker's weight and height limits, should be restrained in a forwardfacing, upright child seat. Of the different seats available, we recommend those that have a fivepoint harness system as shown. We also recommend that a small child use the child seat until the child reaches the weight or height limit for the seat. Child Seat Placement We strongly recommend placing a forward-facing child seat in a back seat, not the front. Placing a forward-facing child seat in the front seat of a vehicle equipped with a passenger's airbag can be hazardous. If the vehicle seat is too far forward, or the child's head is thrown forward during a collision, an inflating airbag can strike the child with enough force to cause very serious or fatal injuries. Even with advanced front airbags that automatically turn the passenger's front airbag off (see page 31 ), a back seat is the safest place for a small child. 40 Driver and Passenger Safety Protecting Infants and Small Children, Selecting a Child Seat If it is necessary to put a forwardfacing child seat in the front, move the vehicle seat as far to the rear as possible, and be sure the child seat is firmly secured to the vehicle and the child is properly strapped in the seat. Placing a forward-facing child seat in the front seat can result in serious injury or death if the front airbag inflates. If you must place a forwardfacing child seat in front, move the vehicle seat as far back as possible, and properly restrain the child. Selecting a Child Seat When buying a child seat, you need to choose either a conventional child seat, or one designed for use with the lower anchors and tethers for children (LATCH) system. Conventional child seats must be secured to a vehicle with a seat belt, whereas LATCH-compatible seats are secured by attaching the seat to hardware built into the two outer seating positions in the back seat. Since LATCH-compatible child seats are easier to install and reduce the possibility of improper installation, we recommend selecting this style. In seating positions and vehicles not equipped with LATCH, a LATCHcompatible child seat can be installed using a seat belt. Whatever type of seat you choose, to provide proper protection, a child seat should meet three requirements: 1. The child seat should meet U.S. or Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213. Look for FMVSS 213 or CMVSS 213 on the box. 2. The child seat should be of the proper type and size to fit the child. Rear-facing for infants, forwardfacing for small children. 3. The child seat should fit the vehicle seating position (or positions) where it will be used. CONTINUED 41 Selecting a Child Seat, Installing a Child Seat Before purchasing a conventional child seat, or using a previously purchased one, we recommend that you test the seat in the specific vehicle seating position or positions where the seat will be used. 42 Installing a Child Seat After selecting a proper child seat and a good place to install the seat, there are three main steps in installing the seat: 1. Properly secure the child seat to the vehicle. All child seats must be secured to the vehicle with the lap part of a lap/shoulder belt or with the LATCH (lower anchors and tethers for children) system. A child whose seat is not properly secured to the vehicle can be endangered in a crash. 2. Make sure the child seat is firmly secured. After installing a child seat, push and pull the seat forward and from side-to-side to verify that it is secure. A child seat secured with a seat belt should be installed as firmly as possible. However, it does not need to be ``rock solid.'' Some side-to-side movement can be expected and should not reduce the child seat's effectiveness. If the child seat is not secure, try installing it in a different seating position, or use a different style of child seat that can be firmly secured. 3. Secure the child in the child seat. Make sure the child is properly strapped in the child seat according to the child seat maker's instructions. A child who is not properly secured in a child seat can be seriously injured in a crash. The following pages provide guidelines on how to properly install a child seat. A forward-facing child seat is used in all examples, but the instructions are the same for a rearfacing child seat. Driver and Passenger Safety Installing a Child Seat Installing a Child Seat with LATCH Your vehicle is equipped with LATCH (lower anchors and tethers for children) at the outer rear seats. The lower anchors are located between the seat-back and seat bottom, and are to be used only with a child seat designed for use with LATCH. Small marks are positioned to indicate the locations of each anchor point. BUTTON LOWER ANCHORS To install a LATCH-compatible child seat: 1. Move the seat belt buckle or tongue away from the lower anchors. 2. Make sure there are no objects near the anchors that could prevent a secure connection between the child seat and the anchors. Rigid type 3. Place the child seat on the vehicle seat, then attach the seat to the lower anchors according to the child seat maker's instructions. Some LATCH-compatible seats have a rigid-type connector as shown above. CONTINUED 43 Installing a Child Seat Front ANCHOR Flexible type Other LATCH-compatible seats have a flexible-type connector as shown above. 4. Whatever type you have, follow the child seat maker's instructions for adjusting or tightening the fit. TETHER STRAP HOOK 5. Lift the head restraint (see page 92 ), then route the tether strap through the legs of the head restraint and over the seat-back, making sure the strap is not twisted. 6. Tighten the strap according to the seat maker's instructions. If the tether strap is too long and cannot be tightened firmly, find a route where the strap can be tightened securely. 7. Attach the tether strap hook to the tether anchor, then tighten the strap as instructed by the child seat maker. 8. Push and pull the child seat forward and from side-to-side to verify that it is secure. 44 Driver and Passenger Safety Installing a Child Seat Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/ Shoulder Belt When not using the LATCH system, all child seats must be secured to the vehicle with the lap part of a lap/ shoulder belt. In addition, the lap/shoulder belts in all seating positions except the driver's have a lockable retractor that must be activated to secure a child seat. 1. With the child seat in the desired seating position, route the belt through the child seat according to the seat maker's instructions, then insert the latch plate into the buckle. 2. To activate the lockable retractor, slowly pull the shoulder part of the belt all the way out until it stops, then let the belt feed back into the retractor. 3. After the belt has retracted, tug on it. If the belt is locked, you will not be able to pull it out. If you can pull the belt out, it is not locked, and you will need to repeat these steps. CONTINUED 45 Installing a Child Seat Installing a Child Seat with a Tether ANCHORAGE POINTS 4. After confirming that the belt is locked, grab the shoulder part of the belt near the buckle, and pull up to remove any slack from the lap part of the belt. Remember, if the lap part of the belt is not tight, the child seat will not be secure. To remove slack, it may help to put weight on the child seat, or push on the back of the seat while pulling up on the belt. 5. Push and pull the child seat forward and from side-to-side to verify that it is secure enough to stay upright during normal driving maneuvers. If the child seat is not secure, unlatch the belt, allow it to retract fully, then repeat these steps. To deactivate the lockable retractor and remove a child seat, unlatch the buckle, unroute the seat belt, and let the belt fully retract. COVER ANCHOR A child seat with a tether can be installed in any seating position in the back seat, using one of the anchorage points shown above. Since a tether can provide additional security to the lap/shoulder belt installation, we recommend using a tether whenever one is required or available. 46 Outer Position Front Center Position Front Installing a Child Seat Driver and Passenger Safety ANCHOR ANCHOR TETHER STRAP HOOK 1. After properly securing the child seat (see page 45 ), lift the head restraint, then route the tether strap over the seat-back and through the head restraint legs. If the tether strap is too long and cannot be tightened firmly, find a route where the strap can be tightened securely. TETHER STRAP HOOK 2. Lift the anchor cover, then attach the tether strap hook to the anchor, making sure the strap is not twisted. 3. Tighten the strap according to the seat maker's instructions. 47 Protecting Larger Children When a child reaches the recommended weight or height limit for a forward-facing child seat, the child should sit in a back seat on a booster seat and wear a lap/shoulder belt. The following pages give instructions on how to check proper seat belt fit, what kind of booster seat to use if one is needed, and important precautions for a child who must sit in front. Allowing a child age 12 or under to sit in front can result in injury or death if the passenger's front airbag inflates. If a child must ride in front, move the vehicle seat as far back as possible, use a booster seat if needed, have the child sit up properly and wear the seat belt properly. Checking Seat Belt Fit To determine if a lap/shoulder belt properly fits a child, have the child put on the seat belt, then ask yourself: 1. Does the child sit all the way back against the seat? 2. Do the child's knees bend comfortably over the edge of the seat? 48 Driver and Passenger Safety Protecting Larger Children 3. Does the shoulder belt cross between the child's neck and arm? 4. Is the lap part of the belt as low as possible, touching the child's thighs? 5. Will the child be able to stay seated like this for the whole trip? If you answer yes to all these questions, the child is ready to wear the lap/shoulder belt correctly. If you answer no to any question, the child needs to ride on a booster seat. Using a Booster Seat A child who has outgrown a forwardfacing child seat should ride in a back seat and use a booster seat until the lap/shoulder belt fits them properly without the booster. Some states and Canadian provinces also require children to use a booster seat until they reach a given age or weight (e.g., 6 years or 60 lbs). Be sure to check current laws in the states or provinces where you intend to drive. Booster seats can be high-back or low-back. Whichever style you select, make sure the booster seat meets federal safety standards (see page 41 ) and that you follow the booster seat maker's instructions. If a child who uses a booster seat must ride in front, move the vehicle seat as far back as possible, and be sure the child is wearing the seat belt properly. A child may continue using a booster seat until the tops of their ears are even with the top of the vehicle's or booster's seat-back. A child of this height should be tall enough to use the lap/shoulder belt without a booster seat. 49 Protecting Larger Children When Can a Larger Child Sit in Front The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration and Transport Canada recommend that all children age 12 and under be properly restrained in a back seat. If the passenger's front airbag inflates in a moderate to severe frontal collision, the airbag can cause serious injuries to a child who is unrestrained, improperly restrained, sitting too close to the airbag, or out of position. A side airbag also poses risks. If any part of a larger child's body is in the path of a deploying side airbag, the child could receive possibly serious injuries. Of course, children vary widely. And while age may be one indicator of when a child can safely ride in front, there are other important factors you should consider. Physical Size Physically, a child must be large enough for the lap/shoulder belt to properly fit (see pages 14 and 48 ). If the seat belt does not fit properly, with or without the child sitting on a booster seat, the child should not sit in front. Maturity To safely ride in front, a child must be able to follow the rules, including sitting properly, and wearing the seat belt properly throughout a ride. If you decide that a child can safely ride up front, be sure to: Carefully read the owner's manual, and make sure you understand all seat belt instructions and all safety information. Move the vehicle seat to the rearmost position. Have the child sit up straight, back against the seat, and feet on or near the floor. Check that the child's seat belt is properly and securely positioned. Supervise the child. Even mature children sometimes need to be reminded to fasten the seat belts or sit properly. 50 Driver and Passenger Safety Protecting Larger Children Additional Safety Precautions Do not let a child wear a seat belt across the neck. This could result in serious neck injuries during a crash. Do not let a child put the shoulder part of a seat belt behind the back or under the arm. This could cause very serious injuries during a crash. It also increases the chance that the child will slide under the belt in a crash and be injured. Two children should never use the same seat belt. If they do, they could be very seriously injured in a crash. Do not put any accessories on a seat belt. Devices intended to improve a child's comfort or reposition the shoulder part of a seat belt can make the belt less effective and increase the chance of serious injury in a crash. 51 Carbon Monoxide Hazard Your vehicle's exhaust contains carbon monoxide gas. Carbon monoxide should not enter the vehicle in normal driving if you maintain your vehicle properly and follow the information on this page. Have the exhaust system inspected for leaks whenever: The vehicle is raised for an oil change. You notice a change in the sound of the exhaust. The vehicle was in an accident that may have damaged the underside. Carbon monoxide gas is toxic. Breathing it can cause unconsciousness and even kill you. Avoid any enclosed areas or activities that expose you to carbon monoxide. High levels of carbon monoxide can collect rapidly in enclosed areas, such as a garage. Do not run the engine with the garage door closed. Even with the door open, run the engine only long enough to move the vehicle out of the garage. With the trunk open, airflow can pull exhaust gas into your vehicle's interior and create a hazardous condition. If you must drive with the trunk open, open all the windows and set the climate control system as shown below. If you must sit in your parked vehicle with the engine running, even in an unconfined area, adjust the heating and cooling system as follows: 1. Select the fresh air mode. 2. Select the mode. 3. Set the fan speed to high. 4. Set the temperature control to a comfortable setting. 52 Driver and Passenger Safety These labels are in the locations shown. They warn you of potential hazards that could cause serious injury or death. Read these labels carefully. If a label comes off or becomes hard to read (except for the U.S. dashboard label, which is removed by the owner), contact your dealer for a replacement. DASHBOARD U.S. models only RADIATOR CAP Safety Labels SUN VISORS U.S. models Canadian models 53 Safety Labels HOOD U.S. models HOOD U.S. models Canadian models Canadian models DOORJAMBS U.S. models Canadian models 54 Instruments and Controls Instruments and Controls This section gives information about the controls and displays that contribute to the daily operation of your vehicle. All the essential controls are within easy reach. Control Locations ............................ 56 Instrument Panel ............................. 57 Instrument Panel Indicators........... 58 Gauges .............................................. 65 Odometer...................................... 65 Display Change Button............... 66 Current Fuel Mileage.................. 66 Temperature Gauge .................... 66 Trip Meter .................................... 67 Average Fuel Mileage................. 67 Fuel Gauge ................................... 67 Outside Temperature Indicator.................................... 68 Check Fuel Cap Message........... 69 Maintenance Minder................... 69 IMA Battery Level Gauge .......... 70 Charge/Assist Gauge ................. 71 Controls Near the Steering Wheel ............................................ 72 Windshield Wipers and Washers .. 73 Turn Signals and Headlights.......... 74 Daytime Running Lights............. 75 Instrument Panel Brightness ......... 75 Hazard Warning Button.................. 76 Rear Window Defogger .................. 76 Steering Wheel Adjustment ........... 77 Keys and Locks................................ 78 Immobilizer System......................... 79 Ignition Switch ................................. 80 Door Locks ....................................... 81 Power Door Locks....................... 81 Childproof Door Locks ............... 82 Auto Door Locking/Unlocking.. 82 Auto Door Locking...................... 82 Auto Door Unlocking .................. 85 Trunk................................................. 88 Emergency Trunk Opener ......... 88 Remote Transmitter........................ 89 Seats .................................................. 91 Seat Heaters ..................................... 96 Power Windows ............................... 97 Mirrors.............................................. 98 Parking Brake .................................. 99 Interior Convenience Items.......... 100 Beverage Holder........................ 101 Accessory Power Socket .......... 101 Glove Box ................................... 101 Console Compartment .............. 101 Interior Lights ................................ 102 55 Control Locations INSTRUMENT PANEL INDICATORS (P. 58) GAUGES (P. 64) AUDIO SYSTEM (P. 110) MIRROR CONTROLS (P. 98) POWER DOOR LOCK MASTER SWITCH (P. 81) POWER WINDOW SWITCHES (P. 97) FUEL FILL DOOR RELEASE HANDLE (P. 255) TRUNK RELEASE HANDLE (P. 88) HORN AUXILIARY INPUT JACK (P. 167) ACCESSORY POWER SOCKET (P. 101) Vehicle with navigation system is shown : If equipped 56 SEAT HEATER SWITCHES (P. 96) USB ADAPTER CABLE (P. 142, 185) CLIMATE CONTROL SYSTEM (P. 104) DOOR LOCK TAB (P. 81) ACCESSORY POWER SOCKET (P. 101) AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION (CVT) (P. 272) Instrument Panel Instruments and Controls SECURITY SYSTEM INDICATOR (P. 62) LOW FUEL INDICATOR (P. 61) DOOR-OPEN INDICATOR (P. 60) BRAKE SYSTEM INDICATOR (AMBER) (P. 63) DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHTS INDICATOR (P. 60) LOW OIL PRESSURE INDICATOR (P. 62, 335) CHARGING SYSTEM INDICATOR (P. 62, 336) CRUISE MAIN INDICATOR (P. 61) CRUISE CONTROL INDICATOR (P. 61) HIGH BEAM LIGHTS ON INDICATOR INDICATOR (P. 60) (P. 60) TRUNK-OPEN INDICATOR (P. 60) IMA SYSTEM INDICATOR (P. 62) IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM INDICATOR (P. 59) MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP (P. 62, 337) VEHICLE STABILITY ASSIST (VSA) SYSTEM INDICATOR2 (P. 64) AUTO IDLE STOP INDICATOR (P. 62, 196, 197) SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM INDICATOR (P. 30, 58) TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM (TPMS) INDICATOR1 (P. 61) ELECTRIC POWER STEERING (EPS) INDICATOR (P. 63) PARKING BRAKE AND BRAKE SYSTEM INDICATOR (RED) (P. 58, 338) SEAT BELT REMINDER INDICATOR (P. 18, 58) MAINTENANCE MINDER INDICATOR (P. 61) ANTI-LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS) INDICATOR (P. 59) VEHICLE STABILITY ASSIST (VSA) ACTIVATION INDICATOR2 (P. 64) LOW TIRE PRESSURE INDICATOR1 (P. 60) SIDE AIRBAG OFF INDICATOR (P. 30, 59) The U.S. instrument panel is shown. Differences for the Canadian models are noted in the text. 1 : Optional in U.S. 2 : If equipped 57 Instrument Panel Indicators The instrument panel has many indicators to give you important information about your vehicle. Seat Belt Reminder Indicator This indicator reminds you and your passengers to fasten your seat belts. If you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position before fastening your seat belt, the beeper sounds and the indicator flashes. If you do not fasten your seat belt before the beeper stops, the indicator stops flashing but remains on. If your front passenger does not fasten their seat belt, the indicator comes on about 6 seconds after the ignition switch is turned to the ON (II) position. If either of you do not fasten your seat belt while driving, the beeper will sound and the indicator will flash again at regular intervals. For more information, see page 18 . U.S. Canada Parking Brake and Brake System Indicator (Red) This indicator has two functions: 1. It comes on when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. It is a reminder to check the parking brake. A beeper sounds if you drive with the parking brake not fully released. Driving with the parking brake not fully released can damage the brakes and tires. 2. If it stays on after you have fully released the parking brake while the engine is running, or if it comes on while driving, there could be a problem with the brake system. For more information, see page 338 . Supplemental Restraint System Indicator This indicator comes on for several seconds when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. If it comes on at any other time, it indicates a potential problem with your front airbags. This indicator will also alert you to a potential problem with your side airbags, passenger's side airbag automatic cutoff system, side curtain airbags, automatic seat belt tensioners, driver's seat position sensor, or the front passenger's weight sensors. For more information, see page 30 . 58 Instruments and Controls Instrument Panel Indicators U.S. Canada Side Airbag Of f Indicator This indicator comes on for several seconds when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. If it comes on at any other time, it indicates that the passenger's side airbag has automatically shut off. For more information, see page 30 . Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) Indicator This indicator normally comes on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. If it comes on at any other time, there is a problem with the ABS. If this happens, have your vehicle checked at a dealer. With this indicator on, your vehicle still has normal braking ability but no anti-lock function. For more information, see page 280 . Immobilizer System Indicator This indicator comes on briefly when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. It will then go off if you have inserted a properly coded ignition key. If it is not a properly coded key, the indicator will blink, and the engine's fuel system will be disabled (see page 79 ). Turn Signal and Hazard Warning Indicators The left or right turn signal indicator blinks when you signal a lane change or turn. If an indicator does not blink or blinks rapidly, it usually means one of the turn signal bulbs is burned out (see pages 307 and 308 ). Replace the bulb as soon as possible, since other drivers cannot see that you are signaling. When you press the hazard warning button, both turn signal indicators and all turn signals on the outside of the vehicle flash. 59 Instrument Panel Indicators ``Daytime Running Lights'' Indicator If this indicator comes on when the ignition switch is turned to the ON (II) position and the parking brake is released, it means there is a problem with a circuit. Have your vehicle checked by your dealer. High Beam Indicator This indicator comes on with the high beam headlights. For more information, see page 74 . This indicator also comes on with reduced brightness when the daytime running lights (DRL) are on (see page 75 ). Lights On Indicator This indicator reminds you that the exterior lights are on. It comes on when the light switch is in either the or position. If you turn the ignition switch to the ACCESSORY (I) or the LOCK (0) position without turning off the light switch, this indicator will remain on. A reminder chime will also sound when you open the driver's door and remove the key from the ignition switch. Trunk-open Indicator This indicator comes on if the trunk lid is not closed tightly. Door-open Indicator This indicator comes on if any door is not closed tightly. Low Tire Pressure Indicator U.S. models only This indicator normally comes on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. If it comes on while driving, it indicates that one or more of your vehicle's tires are significantly low on pressure. If this happens, pull to the side of the road when it is safe, check which tire has lost the pressure, and determine the cause. If it is because of a flat tire, replace the flat tire with the compact spare (see page 325 ), and have the flat tire repaired as soon as possible. If two or more tires are underinflated, call a professional towing service (see page 345 ). For more information, see page 324 . 60 Instruments and Controls Instrument Panel Indicators Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Indicator U.S. models only This indicator normally comes on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. If this indicator comes on and stays on at any other time, or if it does not come on when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position, there is a problem with the TPMS. With this indicator on, the low tire pressure indicator will not come on when a tire loses pressure. Take the vehicle to your dealer to have the system checked. Cruise Main Indicator This indicator comes on when you turn on the cruise control system by pressing the CRUISE button (see page 216 ). Cruise Control Indicator This indicator comes on when you set the cruise control. See page 216 for information on operating the cruise control. Washer Level Indicator Canadian models only This indicator comes on when the washer fluid level is low. Add washer fluid when you see this indicator come on (see page 302 ). Low Fuel Indicator This indicator comes on as a reminder that you must refuel soon. When the indicator comes on, there are about 1.9 US gal (7.5 ) of fuel remaining in the tank. When the reading reaches E, there is a very small amount of fuel in the tank. Maintenance Minder Indicator This indicator reminds you that it is time to take your vehicle in for scheduled maintenance. The maintenance main items and sub items will be displayed in the information display. See page 289 for more information on the maintenance minder. This indicator goes off when your dealer resets it after completing the required maintenance service. 61 Instrument Panel Indicators Security System Indicator SECURITY SYSTEM INDICATOR This indicator comes on when the security system is set. For more information, see page 213 . Malfunction Indicator Lamp See page 337 . Low Oil Pressure Indicator The engine can be severely damaged if this indicator flashes or stays on when the engine is running. For more information, see page 335 . Charging System Indicator If this indicator comes on when the engine is running, the battery is not being charged. For more information, see page 336 . IMA System Indicator This indicator normally comes on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. If it comes on at any other time, it indicates a problem in the integrated motor assist (IMA) system. With the IMA indicator on, the vehicle may not accelerate as it normally does. Have the vehicle checked by the dealer as soon as possible. Auto Idle Stop Indicator See pages 276 and 277 . 62 Instruments and Controls Instrument Panel Indicators Electric Power Steering (EPS) Indicator This indicator normally comes on when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position and goes off after the engine starts. If it comes on at any other time, there is a problem in the electric power steering system. If this happens, stop the vehicle in a safe place, and turn off the engine. Reset the system by restarting the engine. The indicator will not turn off immediately. If it does not go off after driving a short distance, or comes back on again while driving, take the vehicle to your dealer to have it checked. With the indicator on, the EPS may be off, making the vehicle harder to steer. If you turn the steering wheel to the full left or right position repeatedly while stopping or driving at very low speed, you may feel slightly harder steering due to overheating of the steering gearbox. Continuously driving under those conditions could damage the power steering system. U.S. Canada Brake System Indicator (Amber) This indicator normally comes on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. When the brake system indicator (amber) is on, there is the problem with the Cooperative Control with regenerative brake, Creep Aid System or Brake Assist (the normal brake operates properly). Have your vehicle checked by your dealer. For more information, see page 279 . 63 Instrument Panel Indicators Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System Indicator If equipped This indicator normally comes on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. If it comes on and stays on at any other time or it does not come on when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position, there is a problem with the VSA system. Take your vehicle to a dealer to have it checked. Without VSA, your vehicle still has normal driving ability, but will not have VSA traction and stability enhancement. VSA Activation Indicator If equipped This indicator has three functions: 1. It comes on as a reminder that you have turned off the vehicle stability assist (VSA) system. 2. It flashes when VSA is active (see page 285 ). 3. It comes on along with the VSA system indicator if there is a problem with the VSA system. This indicator normally comes on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. For more information, see page 285 . 64 Instruments and Controls Gauges CURRENT FUEL MILEAGE/ TEMPERATURE GAUGE SPEEDOMETER FUEL GAUGE TACHOMETER ODOMETER/OUTSIDE TEMPERATURE INDICATOR TRIP METER SEL/RESET BUTTON DISPLAY CHANGE BUTTON INFORMATION DISPLAY To switch the information display between the odometer, trip meter, outside temperature, and engine oil life and maintenance item code(s), press the SEL/RESET button repeatedly. Odometer The odometer shows the total distance your vehicle has been driven. It measures in miles or kilometers. It is illegal under U.S. federal law and Canadian provincial regulations to disconnect, reset, or alter the odometer with the intent to change the number of miles or kilometers indicated. INSTRUMENT PANEL BRIGHTNESS CONTROL BUTTONS 65 Gauges Display Change Button Every time you press the display change button, the display changes from the current fuel mileage to the temperature gauge, or from the temperature gauge to the current fuel mileage. Press and hold the display change button until you hear a beep. Each time you press the button, the speedometer, trip meter, average fuel mileage and current fuel mileage readings switches their measures. Depending on the selected measures (mph or km/h), the trip meter and odometer readings are shown with miles or km. The average fuel mileage and current fuel mileage are shown with mpg or l/100 km. Current Fuel Mileage This display shows the current, or instant fuel mileage you are getting. It shows the number of mpg or l/100 km. Temperature Gauge This shows the temperature of the engine's coolant. During normal operation, the reading should be in the middle of the gauge. In severe driving conditions, such as very hot weather or a long period of uphill driving, the reading may reach near the red mark. If it reaches the red (Hot) mark, pull safely to the side of the road. See page 333 for instructions and precautions on checking the engine's cooling system. 66 Gauges Trip Meter This meter shows the number of miles or kilometers driven since you last reset it. There are two trip meters: TRIP A and TRIP B. Switch between these displays by pressing the SEL/ RESET button repeatedly. Each trip meter works independently, so you can keep track of two different distances. To reset a trip meter, display it, and then press and hold the SEL/RESET button until the number resets to ``0.0.'' Average Fuel Mileage When either of the trip meters (trip A or trip B) is displayed, your vehicle's average fuel mileage since you last reset that trip meter can be shown on the information display (mpg or l/100km). This number is updated once per 10 seconds. To see the average fuel mileage, press and release the SEL/RESET button repeatedly. The average fuel mileage will be reset when you reset the trip meter, or if the vehicle's battery goes dead or is disconnected. Fuel Gauge This shows how much fuel you have. It may show slightly more or less than the actual amount. Avoid driving with an extremely low f uel level. Running out of f uel could cause the engine to misf ire, damaging the catalytic converter. Instruments and Controls 67 Gauges Outside Temperature Indicator This indicator displays the outside temperature in Fahrenheit (U.S. models) or Celsius (Canadian models). To see the outside temperature, press and release the SEL/RESET button until the temperature is shown on the information display. 68 The temperature sensor is in the front bumper. Therefore, the temperature reading can be affected by heat reflection from the road surface, engine heat, and the exhaust from surrounding traffic. This can cause an incorrect temperature reading when your speed is under 19 mph (30 km/h). The sensor delays the display update until it reaches the correct outside temperature. This may take several minutes. If the outside temperature is incorrectly displayed, you can adjust it up to 5°F (3°C) warmer or cooler. NOTE: The temperature must be stabilized before doing this procedure. Select the outside temperature display, then press and hold the SEL/RESET button for 10 seconds. The following sequence will appear for 1 second each: 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 5, 4, 3, 2, 1, 0 (U.S.) or 0, 1, 2, 3, 3, 2, 1, 0 (Canada). When it reaches the desired value, release the SEL/RESET button. You should see the new outside temperature displayed. In certain weather conditions, temperature readings near freezing (32°F, 0°C) could mean that ice is forming on the road surface. Instruments and Controls Gauges Check Fuel Cap Message Your vehicle's onboard diagnostic system will detect a loose or missing fuel fill cap as an evaporative system leak. The first time a leak is detected a ``CHECK FUEL CAP'' message appears on the information display. Turn the engine off, and confirm the fuel fill cap is installed. If it is, loosen it, then retighten it until it clicks at least once. The message should go off after several days of normal driving once you tighten or replace the fuel fill cap. To scroll to another display, press the SEL/RESET button. The ``CHECK FUEL CAP'' message will appear each time you restart the engine until the system turns the message off. If the system still detects a leak in the vehicle's evaporative emissions system, the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) comes on. If the fuel fill cap was not already tightened, turn the engine off, and check or retighten the fuel fill cap until it clicks at least once. The MIL should go off after several days of normal driving once the cap is tightened or replaced. If the MIL does not go off, have your vehicle inspected by a dealer. For more information, see page 337 . Maintenance Minder The information display in the instrument panel shows you the engine oil life and maintenance service items when the ignition switch is in the ON (II) position. This information helps to keep you aware of the periodic maintenance your vehicle needs for continued troublefree driving. Refer to page 289 for more information. 69 Gauges IMA Battery Level Gauge BATTERY LEVEL GAUGE This gauge shows you the state of charge of the battery for the Integrated Motor Assist (IMA). This battery is recharged by the IMA motor, and discharged by the IMA when it is assisting the engine with powering the vehicle. The gauge reading may drop near the bottom under driving conditions that require IMA motor assistance for a long time, such as prolonged acceleration or climbing a long hill. The IMA motor will recharge the battery as you continue driving. The IMA battery is charged at a higher rate when the transmission is in LOW (L) range (see page 274 ). If the battery is mostly discharged, the Auto Idle Stop function is disabled (see page 276 ). The battery level gauge does not read the battery level directly. It calculates the level by continuously measuring the current flow, voltage, and temperature. Since the level is not read directly, small sensing errors can, over time, cause the gauge to read higher than the actual battery level. The system will then perform a correction, and the battery level gauge reading will drop suddenly. When this happens, IMA assist and Auto Idle Stop are disabled until the IMA battery is sufficiently recharged by normal driving. This should take only a few minutes. This correction of the battery level gauge is normal and does not indicate a problem. If the IMA battery develops a problem or becomes deteriorated, the IMA system indicator will come on. If this happens, have the vehicle checked by your dealer as soon as possible. 70 Charge/Assist Gauge IMA ASSIST GAUGE IMA CHARGE GAUGE This gauge shows you the status of the Integrated Motor Assist (IMA). When the IMA battery is being charged, the bottom side of the gauge illuminates. When the IMA is assisting the engine, the upper side of the gauge illuminates. If the IMA battery is too hot or too cold, the IMA system limits the IMA battery's output power to protect the battery. This disables the IMA assist and Auto Idle Stop, even though the Battery Level Gauge may show that the battery is well-charged. Therefore, if the motor assist is frequently used, the battery becomes hot and starts to limit its output power. It takes the IMA system a few minutes in cold weather to normalize the IMA battery's output power, and about 15 minutes in hot weather. Gauges 71 Instruments and Controls Controls Near the Steering Wheel INSTRUMENT PANEL BRIGHTNESS (P. 75) HEADLIGHTS/TURN SIGNAL (P. 74) WINDSHIELD WIPERS/WASHERS (P. 73) DISPLAY CHANGE BUTTON (P. 66) SEL/RESET BUTTON (P. 65) VEHICLE STABILITY ASSIST (VSA ) SYSTEM OFF SWITCH2 (P. 286) REMOTE AUDIO CONTROL BUTTONS4 (P. 210) HOOD RELEASE HANDLE (P. 176) BLUETOOTH HANDSFREELINK SYSTEM VOICE CONTROL BUTTONS4 (P. 219) Vehicle with navigation system is shown. HORN1 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF INDICATOR (P. 31) HAZARD WARNING BUTTON (P. 76) REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER (P. 77) HEATED MIRRORS3 (P. 96) NAVIGATION SYSTEM VOICE CONTROL BUTTONS4 (P. 219) CRUISE CONTROL BUTTONS STEERING WHEEL (P. 214) ADJUSTMENTS(P. 77) 1 : 2 : 3 : 4 : 72 To use the horn, press the center pad of the steering wheel. If equipped Canadian model only Only on vehicles equipped with navigation system, refer to the navigation system manual. Instruments and Controls Windshield Wipers and Washers ADJUSTMENT RING 1. MIST 2. OFF 3. INT Intermittent 4. LO Low speed 5. HI High speed 6. Windshield washers Push the right lever up or down to select a position. MIST The wipers run at high speed until you release the lever. LO The wipers run at low speed. HI The wipers run at high speed. OFF The wipers are not activated. INT The length of the wiper interval is varied automatically according to the vehicle's speed. Vary the delay by turning the adjustment ring. If you turn it to the shortest delay ( position), the wipers change to low speed operation when the vehicle speed exceeds 12 mph (20 km/h). Windshield Washers Pull the wiper control lever toward you, and hold it. The washers spray until you release the lever. The wipers run at low speed, then complete one more sweep after you release the lever. While the vehicle is stopped and in gear, the wipers sweep the windshield whenever you remove your foot from the brake pedal. 73 Turn Signals and Headlights 1. Turn signal 2. Off 3. Parking and interior lights 4. Headlights 5. High beams 6. Flash high beams 74 Turn Signal Push down on the lever to signal a left turn and up to signal a right turn. To signal a lane change, push lightly on the lever, and hold it. The lever will return to center when you release it or complete a turn. Headlights Turning the switch to the `` '' position turns on the parking lights, taillights, instrument panel lights, sidemarker lights, and rear license plate lights. Turning the switch to the `` '' position turns on the headlights. If you leave the lights on with the key removed from the ignition switch, you will hear a reminder chime when you open the driver's door. High Beams Push the lever forward and the high beam indicator will come on (see page 60 ). Pull it back to return to low beams. To flash the high beams, pull the lever back lightly, then release it. The high beams will stay on as long as you hold the lever back. When the light switch is in the `` '' or `` '' position, the lights on indicator comes on as a reminder. This indicator stays on if you leave the light switch on and turn the ignition switch to the ACCESSORY (I) or the LOCK (0) position. Instruments and Controls Headlights, Instrument Panel Brightness Daytime Running Lights With the headlight switch off or position, the high beam headlights come on with reduced brightness when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position and release the parking brake. They remain on until you turn the ignition switch off, even if you set the parking brake. The headlights revert to normal operation when you turn them on with the switch. Instrument Panel Brightness INSTRUMENT PANEL BRIGHTNESS CONTROL BUTTONS The buttons under the left side vent control the brightness of the instrument panel. Push the or button to adjust the brightness. There are six brightness levels. When you push either button, the information display indicates the current level. You will hear a tone when you reach the maximum or minimum brightness. The display returns to the odometer 5 seconds after you stop adjusting the brightness. To reduce glare at night, the instrument panel illumination dims when you turn the light switch to the or position. The center of each meter (upper and lower) illuminates with reduced brightness when you unlock and open the driver's door, and then goes back to the selected brightness when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. If you insert the key but do not turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position, the illumination turns off in about 10 seconds. 75 Hazard Warning Button, Rear Window Defogger Hazard Warning Button Push the button to turn on the hazard warning lights (four-way flashers). This causes all four outside turn signals and both turn indicators in the instrument panel to flash. Use the hazard warning lights if you need to park in a dangerous area near heavy traffic, or if your vehicle is disabled. Rear Window Defogger U.S. model Canadian model The rear window defogger will clear fog, frost, and thin ice from the window. Push the defogger button to turn it on and off. The indicator in the button comes on to show the defogger is on. If you do not turn it off, the defogger will shut itself off after about 15 minutes. It also shuts off when you turn off the ignition switch. You have to turn the defogger on again when you restart the vehicle. Make sure the rear window is clear and you have good visibility before starting to drive. The defogger wires on the inside of the rear window can be accidentally damaged. When cleaning the glass, always wipe side-to-side. On Canadian models Pushing this button also turns the mirror heaters on or off. For more information, see page 99 . 76 Instruments and Controls Steering Wheel Adjustment Make any steering wheel adjustment before you start driving. Adjusting the steering wheel position while driving may cause you to lose control of the vehicle and be seriously injured in a crash. Adjust the steering wheel only when the vehicle is stopped. 1. Push the lever under the steering column all the way down. 2. Move the steering wheel up or down, and in or out, so it points toward your chest, not toward your face. Make sure you can see the instrument panel gauges and indicators. 3. Push the lever up to lock the steering wheel in that position. 4. Make sure you have securely locked the steering wheel in place by trying to move it up, down, in, and out. 77 Keys and Locks KEY MASTER KEYS NUMBER WITH REMOTE TAG TRANSMITTER VALET KEY (Gray) You should have received a key number tag with your set of keys. You will need this key number if you ever have to get a key replaced. Use only Honda-approved key blanks. These keys contain electronic circuits that are activated by the immobilizer system. They will not work to start the engine if the circuits are damaged. The master key fits all the locks on your vehicle. The valet key works only in the ignition and the door locks. You can keep the trunk and trunk release handle locked when you leave your vehicle and the valet key at a parking facility. Protect the keys from direct sunlight, high temperature, and high humidity. Do not drop the keys or set heavy objects on them. Keep the keys away from liquids. If they get wet, dry them immediately with a soft cloth. The keys without a remote transmitter do not contain batteries. Do not try to take them apart. 78 Instruments and Controls Immobilizer System The immobilizer system protects your vehicle from theft. If an improperly coded key (or other device) is used, the engine's fuel system is disabled. When you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position, the immobilizer system indicator should come on briefly, then go off. If the indicator starts to blink, it means the system does not recognize the coding of the key. Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK (0) position, remove the key, reinsert it, and turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position again. The system may not recognize your key's coding if another immobilizer key or other metal object (i.e. key fob) is near the ignition switch when you insert the key. If the system repeatedly does not recognize the coding of your key, contact your dealer. Do not attempt to alter this system or add other devices to it. Electrical problems could result that may make your vehicle inoperable. If you have lost your key and cannot start your engine, contact your dealer. As required by the FCC: This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user's authority to operate the equipment. Always take the ignition key with you whenever you leave the vehicle alone. This device complies with Industry Canada Standard RSS-210. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference that may cause undesired operation of the device. 79 Ignition Switch The ignition switch has four positions: LOCK (0), ACCESSORY (I), ON (II), and START (III). LOCK (0) You can insert or remove the key only in this position. To turn the key, the shift lever must be in Park, and you must push the key in slightly. If the front wheels are turned, the anti-theft lock may make it difficult to turn the key. Firmly turn the steering wheel to the left or right as you turn the key. ACCESSORY (I) You can operate the audio system and the accessory power sockets in this position. ON (II) This is the normal key position when driving. Several of the indicators on the instrument panel come on as a test when you turn the ignition switch from the ACCESSORY (I) to the ON (II) position. START (III) Use this position only to start the engine. The switch returns to the ON (II) position when you let go of the key. You will hear a reminder beeper if you leave the key in the LOCK (0) or the ACCESSORY (I) position and open the driver's door. Remove the key to turn off the beeper. The shift lever must be in Park before you can remove the key from the ignition switch. 80 Instruments and Controls Door Locks Power Door Locks LOCK TAB To lock To lock To unlock MASTER DOOR LOCK SWITCH Each front door has a master door lock switch. Either switch locks and unlocks all doors. Push the top of the switch to lock all doors; push the bottom to unlock them. To unlock Each door has a lock tab next to the inside door handle. Pull out the tab to lock the door, and push it in to unlock. The lock tab on each door locks and unlocks that door. Pulling out on the driver's door lock tab locks all doors. To unlock the driver's door from the outside, turn the key and release it. If you turn it again, all the doors unlock. To lock any door when getting out of the vehicle, pull the lock tab out, and close the door. To lock the doors when getting out of the vehicle, remove the key from the ignition switch, and push the top of the master door lock switch, then close the door. Lockout Prevention With any door open and the key in the ignition, both master door lock switches and driver's door lock tab are disabled. They are not disabled when all the doors are closed, or when the key is not in the ignition. 81 Door Locks Childproof Door Locks Unlock LEVER Lock The childproof door locks are designed to prevent children seated in the rear from accidentally opening the rear doors. Each rear door has a lock lever near the edge. With the lever in the LOCK position, the door cannot be opened from the inside regardless of the position of the lock tab. To open the door, push the lock tab in, and use the outside door handle. Auto Door Locking/Unlocking Your vehicle has customizable settings for the doors to automatically lock and unlock. There are default settings for each of these features. You can turn off or change the settings for these features as described on the following pages. When you customize the setting, make sure your vehicle is parked safely, the engine is off, and the parking brake is applied. Make all settings before you start driving. Auto Door Locking The auto door locking feature has three possible settings: The auto door locking is deactivated all the time. The doors lock whenever you move the shift lever out of the Park (P) position. The doors lock when the vehicle speed reaches 9 mph (15 km/h). This is the default setting. 82 To turn off the Auto Door Lock modes: Door Locks 3. Push and hold the front of the master door lock switch on the driver's door until you hear a click (after about 5 seconds). 4. Release the switch, and within 5 seconds, turn the ignition switch to the LOCK (0) position. To program the Park Lock mode: Locks all doors when the shift lever is moved out of the Park (P) position. Instruments and Controls 1. Make sure the shift lever is in the Park (P) position. 2. Turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position, and open the driver's door. 1. Make sure the shift lever is in the Park (P) position. 2. Turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position, and make sure to close the driver's door. CONTINUED 83 Door Locks 3. Push and hold the front of the master door lock switch on the driver's door. You will hear a click. Keep holding the switch until you hear another click (after about 5 seconds). 4. Release the switch, and within 5 seconds, turn the ignition switch to the LOCK (0) position. To program the Drive Lock mode: Locks all doors when the vehicle's speed reaches about 9 mph (15 km/h). 1. Make sure the shift lever is in the Park (P) position. 2. Turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position, and make sure to close the driver's door. 3. Push and hold the brake pedal, and move the shift lever out of the Park (P) position. 4. Push and hold the front of the master door lock switch on the driver's door. You will hear a click. Keep holding the switch until you hear another click (after about 5 seconds). 5. Release the switch and, within 5 seconds, turn the ignition switch to the ACCESSORY (I) position. Move the shift lever to the Park (P) position. 6. Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK (0) position. 84 Instruments and Controls Door Locks Auto Door Unlocking The auto door unlocking feature has five possible settings: The auto door unlocking is deactivated all the time. The driver's door unlocks when you move the shift lever to the Park (P) position. This is the default setting. All doors unlock when you move the shift lever to the Park (P) position. The driver's door unlocks whenever you turn the ignition switch to the ACCESSORY (I) position. All doors unlock whenever you turn the ignition switch to the ACCESSORY (I) position. To turn off the Auto Door Unlock modes: 1. Make sure the shift lever is in the Park (P) position. 2. Turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position, and open the driver's door. 3. Push and hold the rear of the master door lock switch on the driver's door. You will hear a click, and after about 5 seconds, you will hear another click. 4. Release the switch, and within 5 seconds, turn the ignition switch to the LOCK (0) position. CONTINUED 85 Door Locks To program the Park Unlock mode: Unlocks the driver's door or all doors when the shift lever is moved into the Park (P) position. 1. Make sure the shift lever is in the Park (P) position. 2. Turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position, and make sure to close the driver's door. 3. Push and hold the rear of the master door lock switch on the driver's door. You will hear a click. Continue to hold down the switch: Until you hear another click (after about 5 seconds) to activate driver's door unlock feature. To program the Ignition Switch Unlock mode: Unlocks the driver's door or all doors when the ignition switch is moved out of the ON (II) position. Or, until you hear two more clicks (after about 10 seconds) to activate all doors unlock feature. 4. Release the switch, and within 5 seconds, turn the ignition switch to the LOCK (0) position. 1. Make sure the shift lever is in the Park (P) position. 2. Turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position, and make sure to close the driver's door. 86 Door Locks 3. Push and hold the brake pedal, then move the shift lever out of the Park (P) position. 4. Push and hold the rear of the master door lock switch on the driver's door. You will hear a click. Continue to hold the switch: 5. Release the switch and, within 5 seconds, turn the ignition switch to the ACCESSORY (I) position. Move the shift lever to the Park (P) position. 6. Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK (0) position. Until you hear another click (after about 5 seconds) to activate driver's door unlock feature. Or, until you hear two more clicks (after about 10 seconds) to activate all doors unlock feature. Even if your vehicle's battery is removed or goes dead, the system keeps the auto door lock/unlock setting which you selected. Instruments and Controls 87 Trunk PULL TRUNK RELEASE HANDLE MASTER KEY To open the trunk, pull the trunk release handle on the left side of the driver's seat. To protect items in the trunk when you need to give the key to someone else, lock the trunk release handle with the master key, and give the other person the valet key. Press and hold the trunk release button on the remote transmitter. To close the trunk, press down on the trunk lid. Keep the trunk lid closed at all times while driving to avoid damaging it, and to prevent exhaust gas from getting into the interior. See Carbon Monoxide Hazard, page 52 . Emergency Trunk Opener RELEASE LEVER As a safety feature, your vehicle has a release lever on the trunk latch so the trunk can be opened from the inside. To open the trunk, push the release lever to the left. Parents should decide if their children should be shown how to use this feature. For more information about child safety, see page 38 . 88 Instruments and Controls Remote Transmitter PANIC BUTTON UNLOCK BUTTON TRUNK RELEASE BUTTON LOCK BUTTON LOCK Press this button once to lock all doors. Some exterior lights will flash once. When you push LOCK twice within 5 seconds, you will hear a horn to verify that the doors are locked. You cannot lock the doors if any door is not fully closed or the key is in the ignition switch. If you push the LOCK button twice within 5 seconds, you will hear a horn to verify that the security system has set. UNLOCK Press this button once to unlock the driver's door. Push it twice to unlock the other doors. Some exterior lights will flash twice each time you press the button. This button does not work when the key is in the ignition switch. The ceiling light (if the ceiling light switch is in the door activated position) will come on when you press the UNLOCK button. If you do not open any door, the light stays on for about 30 seconds, then fades out. If you relock the doors with the remote transmitter before 30 seconds have elapsed, the light goes off immediately. If you unlock the doors with the remote transmitter, but do not open any of the doors within 30 seconds, the doors automatically relock and the security system will also set. PANIC Press this button for about 1 second to attract attention; the horn will sound and the exterior lights will flash for about 30 seconds. To cancel panic mode, press any other button on the remote transmitter, or turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. TRUNK RELEASE Press this button for about 1 second to open the trunk. You cannot open the trunk if the key is in the ignition switch. Remote Transmitter Care Avoid dropping or throwing the transmitter. Protect the transmitter from extreme temperature. Do not immerse the transmitter in any liquid. If you lose a transmitter, the replacement needs to be reprogrammed by your dealer. 89 Remote Transmitter Replacing the Transmitter Battery If it takes several pushes on the button to lock or unlock the doors, replace the battery as soon as possible. Battery type: CR1616 BATTERY SCREW TAB To replace the battery: 1. Remove the screw at the base of the transmitter with a small Phillips-head screwdriver. 2. Separate the transmitter by prying its middle seam with your fingernail. 3. Inside the transmitter, separate the inner cover from the keypad by releasing the two tabs on the cover. 90 Instruments and Controls Remote Transmitter, Seats 4. Remove the old battery from the back of the inner cover, and note the polarity. Make sure the polarity of the new battery is the same ( side facing down), then insert it into the back of the cover. An improperly disposed of battery can hurt the environment. Always confirm local regulations for battery disposal. 5. Install the parts in reverse order. As required by the FCC: This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. Front Seat Adjustments See pages 11 13 for important safety information and warnings about how to properly position seats and seat-backs. Make all adjustments before you start driving. Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user's authority to operate the equipment. This device complies with Industry Canada Standard RSS-210. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference that may cause undesired operation of the device. To adjust the seat forward or backward, pull up on the bar under the seat cushion's front edge. Move the seat to the desired position, and release the bar. Try to move the seat to make sure it is locked in position. CONTINUED 91 Seats Driver's Seat Height Adjustment Head Restraints See page 13 for important safety information and a warning about improperly positioning head restraints. Your vehicle is equipped with head restraints in all seating positions to help protect you and your passengers from whiplash and other injuries. To change the seat-back angle of the front seat, pull up the lever on the outside of the seat bottom. Once a seat is adjusted correctly, rock it back and forth to make sure it is locked in position. The height of your driver's seat is adjustable. To raise the seat, repeatedly pull up the lever on the outside of the seat cushion. To lower the seat, push the lever down repeatedly. 92 Front CUSHION Seats Rear Center Position CUSHION LEG Instruments and Controls They are most effective when you adjust them so the center of the back of the occupant's head rests against the center of the restraint. LEGS SEAT-BACK RELEASE BUTTON SEAT-BACK RELEASE BUTTON Adjusting the Head Restraint The head restraints adjust for height. You need both hands to adjust a restraint. Do not attempt to adjust it while driving. To raise it, pull upward. To lower the restraint, push the release button sideways, and push the restraint down. When a passenger is seated in the rear center seating position, make sure the center head restraint is adjusted to its highest position. 93 Seats Removing the Head Restraint To remove a head restraint for cleaning or repair, pull it up as far as it will go. Push the release button, then pull the restraint out of the seatback. Failure to reinstall the head restraints can result in severe injury during a crash. Always replace the head restraints before driving. When reinstalling a head restraint, put the legs back in place. Then adjust it to the appropriate height while pressing the release button. Make sure the head restraint locks in position when you reinstall it. Active Head Restraints The driver's and front passenger's seats have active head restraints. If the vehicle is struck severely from the rear, the occupant properly secured with the seat belt will be pushed against the seat-back and the head restraint will automatically move forward. This reduces the distance between the restraint and the occupant's head. It also helps protect the occupants against whiplash and injuries to the neck and upper spine. After a collision, the activated restraint should return to its normal position. If the restraints do not return to their normal position, or in the event of a severe collision, have the vehicle inspected by a Honda dealer. 94 For a head restraint system to work properly: Armrest Do not hang any items on the head restraints, or from the restraint legs. Do not place any object between an occupant and the seat-back. Install each restraint in its proper location. Only use genuine Honda replacement head restraints. The lid of the console compartment can be used as an armrest by moving it forward and backward. Make sure the armrest is securely latched. Make sure your passenger's hands or fingers are away from the armrest before moving it. Seats 95 Instruments and Controls Seat Heaters Passenger's Seat HEATERS Driver's Seat If equipped Both front seats are equipped with seat heaters. Because of the sensors for the side airbag cutoff system, there is no heater in the passenger's seat-back. The ignition switch must be in the ON (II) position to use the heaters. In the HI setting, the heater turns off when the seat gets warm, and turns back on after the seat's temperature drops. In the LO setting, the heater runs continuously. It does not cycle with temperature changes. SEAT HEATER SWITCH Push the front of the switch, HI, to rapidly heat up the seat. After the seat reaches a comfortable temperature, select LO by pushing the back of the switch. This will keep the seat warm. Follow these precautions whenever you use the seat heaters: Use the HI setting only to heat the seats quickly, because it draws large amounts of current from the battery. If the engine is left idling for an extended period, do not use the seat heaters even on the LO setting. It can weaken the battery, causing hard starting. 96 Instruments and Controls Power Windows DRIVER'S WINDOW SWITCH Closing a power window on someone's hands or fingers can cause serious injury. Make sure your passengers are away from the windows before closing them. MAIN SWITCH Turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position to raise or lower any window. To open the window, push the switch down and hold it. Release the switch when you want to stop the window. To close the window, pull back on the switch and hold it. The windows operate for up to 10 minutes after you turn off the ignition switch. Opening either front door cancels this function. If the MAIN switch is OFF, the passenger windows cannot be raised or lowered. Keep the MAIN switch off when you have children in the vehicle so they do not injure themselves by operating the windows unintentionally. AUTO To open or close the driver's window, push or pull the window switch firmly down or up to the second detent, and release it. The window will automatically go down or up all the way. To stop the window, pull or push the window switch briefly. AUTO REVERSE If the driver's window senses any obstacle while it is closing automatically, it will reverse direction, and then stop. To close the window, remove the obstacle, then use the window switch again. Auto reverse stops sensing when the window is almost closed. You should always check that all passengers and objects are away from the window before closing it. 97 Mirrors TAB Adjusting the Power Mirrors SELECTOR SWITCH ADJUSTMENT SWITCH Keep the inside and outside mirrors clean and adjusted for best visibility. Be sure to adjust the mirrors before you start driving. The inside mirror has day and night positions. The night position reduces glare from headlights behind you. Flip the tab on the bottom edge of the mirror to select the day or night position. 1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. 2. Move the selector switch to L (driver's side) or R (passenger's side). 3. Push the appropriate edge of the adjustment switch to move the mirror right, left, up, or down. 4. When you finish, move the selector switch to the center (off) position. This turns the adjustment switch off to keep your settings. 98 Heated Mirrors Parking Brake Mirrors, Parking Brake Driving the vehicle with the parking brake applied can damage the rear brakes and hubs. A beeper will sound if the vehicle is driven with the parking brake on. Instruments and Controls HEATED MIRROR BUTTON On Canadian models The outside mirrors are heated to remove fog and frost. With the ignition switch in the ON (II) position, turn on the heaters by pressing the button. The indicator in the button comes on as a reminder. Press the button again to turn the heaters off. Pressing this button also turns the rear window defogger on and off. PARKING BRAKE LEVER To apply the parking brake, pull the lever up fully. To release it, pull up slightly, push the button, and lower the lever. The parking brake indicator on the instrument panel should go out when the parking brake is fully released (see page 58 ). 99 Interior Convenience Items COAT HOOK CONSOLE COMPARTMENT COIN BOX CENTER POCKET VANITY MIRROR ACCESSORY POWER SOCKET GLOVE BOX ACCESSORY POWER SOCKET : If equipped 100 USB ADAPTER CABLE BEVERAGE HOLDERS Instruments and Controls Interior Convenience Items Beverage Holders Be careful when you are using the beverage holders. A spilled liquid that is very hot can scald you or your passengers. Spilled liquids can damage the upholstery, carpeting, and electrical components in the interior. Open the front beverage holder by sliding its cover backward. Accessory Power Socket This socket is intended to supply power for 12 volt DC accessories that are rated 120 watts or less (10 amps). It will not power an automotive type cigarette lighter element. To use an accessory power socket, the ignition switch must be in the ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position. On models without navigation system Another accessory power socket is in the center console compartment. When more than one socket is being used, the combined power rating of the accessories should be 120 watts or less (10 amps). Glove Box Open the glove box by pulling the handle to the left. Close it with a firm push. An open glove box can cause serious injury to your passenger in a crash, even if the passenger is wearing the seat belt. Always keep the glove box closed while driving. Console Compartment LEVER ACCESSORY POWER SOCKET CONSOLE COMPARTMENT To open the console compartment, pull up on the lever, and lift the lid. To close, lower the lid, and push it down until it latches. 101 Interior Lights Ceiling Light DOOR ACTIVATED ON OFF The ceiling light has a three-position switch: ON, Door Activated, and OFF. In the Door Activated (center) position, the light comes on when you: Open any door. Unlock the doors with the key or remote transmitter. Remove the key from the ignition. After all doors are closed tightly, the light dims slightly, then fades out in about 30 seconds. If you do not open any door after you unlock the driver's door or remove the key from the ignition switch, the light(s) fades out in about 30 seconds. If you leave either door open without the key is in the ignition switch, the ceiling light will go off after 3 minutes. Spotlights The front ceiling light has two spotlights. Push the spotlight lenses to turn them on and off. 102 Features Features The climate control system in your vehicle provides a comfortable driving environment in all weather conditions. The standard audio system has many features. This section describes those features and how to use them. (If you have an optional audio system, refer to the operating instructions that came with it.) Your vehicle has an anti-theft audio system that requires a code number to enable it. The security system helps to discourage vandalism and theft of your vehicle. Climate Control.............................. 104 Audio System ................................. 110 Audio System (Models without navigation system) .................... 112 Playing the AM/FM Radio........... 113 Adjusting the Sound ...................... 115 Playing the XM Radio ................. 116 Playing a Disc................................. 121 Disc Player Error Messages ........ 128 Optional Disc Changer Error Messages .................................... 129 Playing an iPod ............................. 130 iPod Error Messages .................. 138 Playing a USB Flash Memory Device ......................................... 139 USB Flash Memory Device Error Messages ......................... 146 Audio System (Models with navigation system) .................... 147 Playing the AM/FM Radio........... 148 Playing the XM Radio ................. 151 Adjusting the Sound ...................... 158 Playing a Disc................................. 160 Disc Player Error Messages ........ 169 Playing a PC Card.......................... 170 PC Card Error Messages.............. 182 Playing an iPod ............................. 183 iPod Error Messages .................. 192 Playing a USB Flash Memory Device ......................................... 193 USB Flash Memory Device Error Messages ......................... 203 AM/FM Radio Reception............. 204 Protecting Your Discs................... 206 Radio Theft Protection.................. 209 Remote Audio Controls................. 210 Auxiliary Input Jack....................... 211 Setting the Clock ........................... 212 Security System ............................. 213 Cruise Control................................ 214 Bluetooth HandsFreeLink ........ 217 103 Climate Control AUTO BUTTON TEMPERATURE CONTROL DIAL FAN CONTROL DIAL MODE CONTROL BUTTON 104 AIR CONDITIONING BUTTON REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER BUTTON FRESH AIR BUTTON RECIRCULATION BUTTON WINDSHIELD DEFROST BUTTON OFF BUTTON Climate Control Voice Control System Only on models equipped with Navigation System The climate control system for your vehicle can also be operated using the voice control system. See the Navigation section in your Quick Start Guide for an overview of this system and the Navigation System manual for complete details. Using Automatic Climate Control The automatic climate control system adjusts the fan speed and airflow levels to maintain the interior temperature you select. Press the AUTO button. Set the desired temperature by turning the temperature control dial. You will see AUTO in the system's display. The system automatically selects the proper mix of conditioned and/or heated air that will, as quickly as possible, raise or lower the interior temperature to your preference. When you set the temperature to its lower limit ( ) or its upper limit ( ), the system runs at full cooling or heating only. It does not regulate the interior temperature. In cold weather, the fan will not come on automatically until the heater starts to develop warm air. In ``AUTO'' mode, the air conditioner may not work if the humidity inside the vehicle is low. To activate the air conditioner, press A/C button. Semi-automatic Operation You can manually select various functions of the climate control system when it is in full automatic mode. All other features remain automatically controlled. Making any manual selection causes the word AUTO in the display to go out. Fan Control Dial Turn this dial to increase or decrease the fan speed and airflow. Temperature Control Dial Turning this dial clockwise increases the temperature of the airflow. Features 105 Climate Control Air Conditioning (A/C) Button This button turns the air conditioning on and off. The indicator in the button is on when the A/C is on. Recirculation Button When the recirculation indicator is on, air from the vehicle's interior is sent throughout the system again. To select recirculation mode when driving through dusty or smoky conditions, then return to fresh air mode. Fresh Air Button The outside air intakes for the heating and cooling system are at the base of the windshield. Keep this area clear of leaves and other debris. When the flesh air indicator is on, air is brought in from the outside of the vehicle. The system should be left in fresh air mode under almost all conditions. Keeping the system in recirculation mode, particularly with the A/C off, can cause the windows to fog up. Mode Control Button Use the mode control buttons to select the vents air flows from. Some air will flow from the dashboard corner vents in all modes. Air flows from the center and corner vents in the dashboard. Airflow is divided between the vents in the dashboard and the floor vents. Air flows from the floor vents. When you select , the system automatically switches to fresh air mode. Airflow is divided between the floor vents and defroster vents at the base of the windshield. Air flows from the defroster vents at the base of the windshield. When you select , the system automatically switches to fresh air mode and turns on the A/C. In AUTO mode, the system controls the airflow direction automatically between the dashboard vents and the floor vents. 106 Features Climate Control Ventilation The flow-through ventilation system draws in outside air, circulates it through the interior, then releases it through vents near the rear window. 1. Set the temperature to the lower limit. 2. Make sure the A/C is off. 3. Select and fresh air mode. 4. Set the fan to the desired speed. Using the Heater The heater uses engine coolant to warm the air. If the engine is cold, it will be several minutes before you feel warm air coming from the system. 1. Select . When you select , the system automatically switches to the fresh air mode. 2. Set the fan to the desired speed. 3. Adjust the warmth of the air with the temperature control dial. Using the A/C Air conditioning places an extra load on the engine. Watch the engine coolant temperature gauge (see page 66 ). If it moves near the red zone, turn off the A/C until the gauge reading returns to normal. 1. Turn on the A/C by pressing the button. The indicator in the button comes on when a fan speed is selected. 2. Make sure the temperature is set to maximum cool. 3. Select . 4. If the outside air is humid, select recirculation mode. If the outside air is dry, select fresh air mode. 5. Set the fan to the desired speed. If the interior is very warm, you can cool it down more rapidly by partially opening the windows, turning on the A/C, and setting the fan to maximum speed in fresh air mode. Dehumidify the Interior Air conditioning, as it cools, removes moisture from the air. When used in combination with the heater, it makes the interior warm and dry and can prevent the windows from fogging up. 1. Turn the fan on. 2. Turn on the air conditioning. 3. Select and fresh air mode. 4. Adjust the temperature to your preference. This setting is suitable for all driving conditions whenever the outside temperature is above 32°F (0°C). 107 Climate Control To Defog and Defrost To remove fog from the inside of the windows: 1. Set the fan to the desired speed, or high for faster defrosting. 2. Select . When you select , the system automatically switches to fresh air mode and turns on the A/C. The A/C indicator will not come on, if it was previously off. 3. Adjust the temperature so the airflow feels warm. 4. Select to help clear the rear window. 5. To increase airflow to the windshield, close the corner vents. To Remove Exterior Frost or Ice From the Windows 1. Select . When you select , the system automatically switches to fresh air mode and turns on the A/C. The A/C indicator will not come on, if it was previously off. 2. Select . 3. Set the fan and temperature controls to maximum level. To clear the windows faster, you can close the dashboard corner vents by rotating the wheel below each vent. This sends more warm air to the windshield defroster vents. Once the windshield is clear, select fresh air mode to avoid fogging the windows. For your safety, make sure you have a clear view through all the windows before driving. 108 To Turn Everything Off Press the OFF button. However, a lack of airflow can cause the windows to fog up. You should keep the fan on at all times so stale air and moisture do not build up in the interior and cause fogging. Sunlight, Temperature, and Humidity Sensors Climate Control Features SUNLIGHT SENSOR To regulate the interior temperature and humidity, the climate control system has two sensors. A sunlight sensor is located in the top of the dashboard and a temperature/ humidity sensor is next to the steering column. Do not cover the sensors or spill any liquid on them. TEMPERATURE/HUMIDITY SENSOR 109 Audio System Read the appropriate pages in this section for operation of the audio systems installed in your vehicle. For vehicles without navigation system, see pages 112 through 146 . For vehicles with navigation system, see pages 147 through 203 . If your vehicle has a different audio system, refer to its manual for operating instructions. On models without navigation system 110 U.S. model with navigation system Audio System Features 111 Audio System (Models without navigation system) SCAN BUTTON AM/FM BUTTON AUTO SELECT BUTTON 112 PWR/VOL KNOB SEEK BUTTON PRESET BUTTONS TUNE/SOUND KNOB Features Playing the AM/FM Radio (Models without navigation system) To Play the AM/FM Radio The ignition switch must be in the ACCESSORY (I) or the ON (II) position. Turn the system on by pushing the PWR/VOL knob or the AM/FM button. Adjust the volume by turning the same knob. The band and frequency that the radio was last tuned to is displayed. To change bands, press the AM/FM button. On the FM band, ST will be displayed if the station is broadcasting in stereo. Stereo reproduction in AM is not available. To Select a Station You can use any of five methods to find radio stations on the selected band: TUNE, SEEK, SCAN, the preset buttons, and AUTO SELECT. TUNE Use the TUNE knob to tune the radio to a desired frequency. Turn the knob right to tune to a higher frequency, or left to tune to a lower frequency. SEEK The seek function searches up and down from the current frequency to find a station with a strong signal. To activate it, press the or side of the SEEK bar, then release it. SCAN The scan function samples all stations with strong signals on the selected band. To activate it, press the SCAN button, then release it. You will see SCAN in the display. The system will scan for a station with a strong signal. When it finds one, it will stop and play that station for about 10 seconds. If you do nothing, the system will then scan for the next strong station and play it for 10 seconds. When it plays a station you want to listen to, press the SCAN button again. Preset Each side of the buttons (1 through 6) can store one frequency on AM, and two frequencies on FM. 1. Select the desired band, AM or FM. FM1 and FM2 let you store six stations each. 2. Use the tune, seek, or scan function to tune the radio to a desired station. 3. Pick a preset number (16), and hold it until you hear a beep. 4. Repeat steps 1 through 3 to store a total of six stations on AM and twelve stations on FM. CONTINUED 113 Playing the AM/FM Radio (Models without navigation system) AUTO SELECT If you are traveling far from home and can no longer receive your preset stations, you can use the auto select feature to find stations in the local area. Press the A. SEL button. ``A.SEL'' flashes in the display, and the system goes into scan mode for several seconds. It stores the frequencies of six AM, and twelve FM stations in the preset buttons. You will see a ``0'' displayed after pressing a preset button if auto select cannot find a strong station for that preset button. If you do not like the stations auto select has stored, you can store other frequencies on the preset buttons as previously described. To turn off auto select, press the A. SEL (auto select) button. This restores the presets you originally set. For information on AM/FM radio frequencies and reception, see page 204 . 114 Features Adjusting the Sound (Models without navigation system) Press the SOUND (TUNE) knob repeatedly to display the BASS, TREBLE, FADER, BALANCE, and SVC (speed-sensitive volume compensation) settings. Each mode is shown in the display as it changes. Turn the SOUND (TUNE) knob to adjust the setting to your liking. When the level reaches the center, you will see `` '' in the display. The system will automatically return the display to the selected audio mode about 5 seconds after you stop adjusting a mode. Treble/Bass Use the TREBLE/ BASS modes to adjust the tone to your liking. Balance/Fader These two modes adjust the strength of the sound coming from each speaker. BALANCE adjusts the side-to-side strength, while FADER adjusts the front-to-back strength. Speed-sensitive volume compensation (SVC) The SVC mode controls the volume based on vehicle speed. The faster you go, the louder the audio volume becomes. As you slow down, the audio volume decreases. The SVC has four modes; SVC OFF, SVC LOW, SVC MID, and SVC HIGH. The default setting is MID. Turn the SOUND (TUNE) knob to adjust the setting to your liking. If you feel the sound is too loud, choose low. If you feel the sound is too quiet, choose high. Audio System Lighting You can use the instrument panel brightness control buttons to adjust the illumination of the audio system (see page 75 ). The audio system illuminates when the parking lights are on, even if the radio is off. 115 Playing the XM Radio (Models without navigation system) Optional on U.S. models Your audio system is capable of receiving XM Radio anywhere in the United States, except Hawaii and Alaska. XM is a registered trademark of XM Satellite Radio , Inc. XM Radio receives signals from two satellites to produce clear, highquality digital reception. It offers many channels in several categories. Along with a large selection of different types of music, XM Radio allows you to view channel and category selections in the display. POWER/VOLUME KNOB SCAN BUTTON CD BUTTON DISPLAY BUTTON AUX BUTTON 116 PRESET BUTTONS TUNE KNOB Playing the XM Radio (Models without navigation system) Operating the XM Radio To listen to XM Radio, turn the ignition switch to the ACCESSORY (I) or the ON (II) position. Push the power/volume knob to turn on the audio system, and press the ``AUX'' button. Adjust the volume by turning the knob. The last channel you listened to will show in the display. MODE To switch between channel mode and category mode, press and hold the DISP button until the mode changes. In channel mode, you can select all of the available channels. In category mode, such as Jazz, Rock, Classical, etc., you can select all of the channels within that category. Each time you press and release the DISP button, the display changes in the following sequence: Channel name, channel number, category, artist name, and music title. You may experience periods when XM Radio does not transmit the artist's name and song title information. If this happens, there is nothing wrong with your system. TUNE Turn the TUNE knob to change channel selections. Turn the knob right for higher numbered channels and left for lower numbered channels. In the category mode, you can only select channels within that category. SEEK/SKIP (CATEGORY) Press either side of the CATEGORY button ( or ) to select another category. Features CONTINUED 117 Playing the XM Radio (Models without navigation system) SCAN The scan function gives you a sampling of all channels while in the channel mode. In the category mode, only the channels within that category are scanned. To activate scan, press the SCAN button. The system plays each channel in numerical order for a few seconds, then selects the next channel. When you hear a channel you want to continue listening to, press the button again. Preset You can store up to 12 preset channels using each side of the preset button. Each side of the button stores one channel from the XM1 band and one channel from the XM2 band. To store a channel: 1. Press the AUX button. Either XM1 or XM2 will show in the display. 2. Use the tune, seek, or scan function to tune to a desired channel. In category mode, only channels within that category can be selected. In channel mode, all channels can be selected. 3. Pick a preset number you want for that channel. Press and hold the button until you hear a beep. 4. Repeat steps 2 and 3 to store the first six channels. 5. Press the AUX button again. Store the next six channels using steps 2 and 3. Once a channel is stored, press and release the proper side of the preset button to tune to it. XM Radio Display Messages ``LOADING'' XM is loading the audio or program information. ``OFF AIR'' The channel currently selected is no longer broadcasting. ``UPDATING'' The encryption code is being updated. Wait until the encryption code is fully updated. Channels 0 and 1 should still work normally. ``NO SIGNAL'' The signal is currently too weak. Move the vehicle to an area away from tall buildings, and with an unobstructed view of the southern horizon. 118 Playing the XM Radio (Models without navigation system) `` - - - - '' The selected channel number does not exist, or is not part of your subscription, or this channel has no artist or title information at this time. ``ANTENNA'' There is a problem with the XM antenna. Please consult your dealer. Signal may be blocked by Signal weaker in mountains or large obstacles to these areas. the south. SATELLITE Features The XM satellites are in orbit over the equator; therefore, objects south of the vehicle may cause satellite reception interruptions. To help compensate for this, ground-based repeaters are placed in major metropolitan areas. GROUND REPEATER Satellite signals are more likely to be blocked by tall buildings and mountains the farther north you travel from the equator. Carrying large items on a roof rack can also block the signal. CONTINUED 119 Playing the XM Radio (Models without navigation system) Depending on where you drive, you may experience reception problems. Interference can be caused by any of these conditions: Driving on the north side of an east/west mountain road. Driving on the north side of a large commercial truck on an east/west road. Driving in tunnels. Driving on a road beside a vertical wall, steep cliff, or hill to the south of you. Driving on the lower level of a multi-tiered road. Driving on a single lane road alongside dense trees taller than 50 ft. (15 m) to the south of you. Large items carried on a roof rack. There may be other geographic situations that could affect XM Radio reception. As required by the FCC: Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user's authority to operate the equipment. Receiving XM Radio Service If your XM Radio service has expired or you purchased your vehicle from a previous owner, you can listen to a sampling of the broadcasts available on XM Radio. With the ignition switch in the ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position, push the power/volume knob to turn on the audio system and press the AUX button. A variety of music types and styles will play. If you decide to purchase XM radio service, contact XM Radio at www.xmradio.com, or at 1-800-852-9696. You will need to give them your radio I.D. number and your credit card number. To get your radio I.D. number, turn the TUNE knob until ``0'' appears in the display. Your I.D. will appear in the display. After you've registered with XM Radio, keep your audio system in the satellite radio mode while you wait for activation. This should take about 30 minutes. While waiting for activation, make sure your vehicle remains in an open area with good reception. Once your audio system is activated, you'll be able to listen to XM Radio broadcasts. XM Radio will continue to send an activation signal to your vehicle for at least 12 hours from the activation request. If the service has not been activated after 36 hours, contact XM Radio. 120 Playing a Disc (Models without navigation system) LOAD INDICATOR CD BUTTON REPEAT RANDOM BUTTON BUTTON DISPLAY BUTTON Features EJECT BUTTON SCAN BUTTON PWR/VOL KNOB SEEK/SKIP BUTTON FOLDER KNOB 121 Playing a Disc (Models without navigation system) To Play a Disc To load or play discs, the ignition switch must be in the ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position. You operate the CD player with the same controls used for the radio. To select the CD player, press the CD button. You will see ``CD'' in the display. The number of the track playing is shown in the display. The system will continuously play a disc until you change modes. The disc player can also play CD-Rs and CD-RWs compressed in CDTEXT, MP3, and WMA formats. When playing a disc in MP3 or WMA, you will see ``MP3'' or ``WMA'' in the display. You can select up to 255 folders or tracks. Video CDs and DVDs will not work in this unit. The specifications for compatible MP3 files are: Sampling frequency: 32/44.1/48 kHz (MPEG1) 16/22.05/24 kHz (MPEG2) Bitrate: 32/40/48/56/64/80/96/112/128/ 160/192/224/256/320 kbps (MPEG1) 8/16/24/32/40/48/56/64/80/96/ 112/128/160 kbps (MPEG2) Compatible with variable bitrate and multi-session Maximum layers (including ROOT): 8 layers The specifications for compatible WMA files are: Sampling frequency: 32/44.1/48 kHz Bitrate: 48/64/80/96/128/160/192 kbps Compatible with variable bitrate and multi-session Maximum layers (including ROOT): 8 layers Insert the disc about halfway into the disc slot. The drive will pull the disc in the rest of the way and begin to play it. When the system reaches the end of the disc, it will return to the beginning and play the disc again. You cannot load and play 3-inch (8-cm) discs in this system. To play the radio when a disc is playing, press the AM/FM button. Press the CD button again to switch back to the disc player. Do not use discs with adhesive labels. The label can curl up and cause the disc to jam in the unit. 122 Features Playing a Disc (Models without navigation system) Text Data Display Function Each time you press the DISP button, the display shows you the text data on a disc, if the disc was recorded with text data. You will also see some text data under these conditions: When a new folder, file, or track is selected. You can see the album, artist, and track name in the display. If a disc is recorded in MP3 or WMA, you can see the folder and file name, and the artist, album, and track tag. With the folder name, you will see the FOLDER indicator in the display. The TRACK indicator is shown with the file or track name. The display shows up to 16 characters of selected text data (the folder name, file name, etc.). If the text data has more than 16 characters, you will see the first 15 characters and the indicator in the display. Press and hold the DISP button until the next 16 characters are shown. When you change the audio mode to play a disc with text data or in MP3 or WMA. When you insert a disc, and the system begins to play. When playing a CD-DA with text data, the album and track name are shown in the display. With a disc in MP3 or WMA, the display shows the folder and file name. To Change or Select Tracks/Files Use the SEEK/SKIP button while a disc is playing to select passages and change tracks (files in MP3/WMA mode). In MP3/WMA mode, use the FOLDER knob to select folders on the disc, and use the SEEK/SKIP button to change files. CONTINUED 123 Playing a Disc (Models without navigation system) SEEK/SKIP Each time you press and release the side of the SEEK/SKIP button, the player skips forward to the beginning of the next track (file in MP3 or WMA mode). Press and release the side to skip backward to the beginning of the current track. Press it again to skip to the beginning of the previous track. To move rapidly within a track, press and hold the or side of the SEEK/SKIP button. In MP3 or WMA mode FOLDER SELECTION To select a different folder, turn the TUNE knob to move to the beginning of the next folder. Turn the knob to the right to skip to the next folder, and to the left to move to the beginning of the current folder. Turn it again to skip to the beginning of the previous folder. Turning the TUNE knob more than one click skips several folders at a time. REPEAT (TRACK/FILE REPEAT) To continuously replay a track (files in MP3 or WMA mode), press and release the RPT button. You will see ``RPT'' in the display. Press and hold the RPT button for 2 seconds to turn it off. 124 Playing a Disc (Models without navigation system) In MP3 or WMA mode FOLDER-REPEAT This feature, when activated, replays all files in the selected folder in the order they are compressed. To activate folder repeat, press the RPT button twice. You will hear a beep and see F-RPT in the display. The system continuously replays the current folder. Press the RPT button again to turn it off. Pressing the RDM button, or selecting a different folder with the TUNE knob also turns off the repeat feature. Each time you press and release the RPT button, the mode changes from file repeat to folder repeat, then to normal play. RANDOM (Random within a disc/folder) This feature plays the tracks within a disc (the files within a folder in MP3 or WMA mode) in random order. To activate random play, press and release the RDM button. In MP3 or WMA mode, press the RDM button repeatedly to select RDM (within a folder random play). You will see RDM in the display. Press the RDM button for 2 seconds to return to normal play. In MP3 or WMA mode FOLDER-RANDOM This feature, when activated, plays all files in each folder in random order. To activate folder random, press the RDM button twice. You will hear a beep and see F-RDM in the display. The system will then select and play files randomly. This continues until you deactivate folder random by pressing the RDM button again, or by selecting a different folder with the TUNE knob. Each time you press and release the RDM button, the mode changes from folder random play to random play (within a folder random play), then to normal play. Features CONTINUED 125 Playing a Disc (Models without navigation system) SCAN (TRACK/FILE SCAN) The scan function samples all tracks (files in MP3 or WMA) on the disc in the order they are recorded on the disc. To activate scan, press the SCAN button. In MP3 or WMA mode, press the SCAN button repeatedly to select SCAN. You will see SCAN in the display. You will get a 10 second sampling of each track/ file on the disc. Press the SCAN button again to get out of scan mode and play the last track/file sampled. Pressing either side of the SEEK/ SKIP button also turns off the scan feature. In MP3 or WMA mode F-SCAN (FOLDER SCAN) This feature, when activated, samples the first file of each folder on the disc. To activate folder scan, press the SCAN button twice. You will see F-SCAN in the display. The system plays the first file in the first folder for about 10 seconds. If you do nothing, the system will then play the first files in the next folders for 10 seconds. After playing the first file of the last folder, the system plays normally. Pressing either side of the SEEK/ SKIP button, selecting a different folder with the TUNE knob, or pressing the SCAN button, also turns off the folder scan. Each time you press and release the SCAN button, the mode changes from file scan to folder scan, then to normal play. To Stop Playing a Disc Press the eject button ( ) to remove the disc. If you eject the disc, but do not remove it from the slot, the system will automatically reload it after 10 seconds and put it in pause mode. To begin playing, press the CD button. You can also eject the disc when the ignition switch is off. To play the radio when a disc is playing, press the AM/FM button. Press the AUX button to switch to an appropriate audio unit (if it is connected to the auxiliary input jack or the USB adapter cable). Press the CD button again to switch back to the disc player. 126 Playing a Disc (Models without navigation system) If you turn the system off while a disc is playing, either with the power/volume knob or by turning off the ignition switch, the disc will stay in the drive. When you turn the system back on, the disc will begin playing where it left off. Operating the Optional Disc Changer An optional six or eight disc changer is available for your vehicle. This disc changer uses the same controls used for the in-dash disc player or the radio. Load the desired discs in the magazine, and load the magazine in the changer according to the instructions that came with the unit. To select the disc changer, press the CD button. The disc and track numbers will be displayed. To select a different disc, use the preset 4 (DISC ) or the preset 1 (DISC ) on the preset button. To select the previous disc, press the preset 4 (DISC ), or the preset 1 (DISC ) to select the next disc in sequence. If you select an empty slot in the magazine, the changer will search for the next available disc to load and play. Protecting Discs For information on how to handle and protect compact discs, see page 206 . Features 127 Disc Player Error Messages (Models without navigation system) The chart on the right explains the error messages you may see in the display while playing a disc. If you see an error message in the display while playing a disc, press the eject button. After ejecting the disc, check it for damage or deformation. If there is no damage, insert the disc again. For additional information on damaged discs, see page 207 . The audio system will try to play the disc. If there is still a problem, the error message will reappear. Press the eject button, and pull out the disc. Insert a different disc. If the new disc plays, there is a problem with the first disc. If the error message cycle repeats and you cannot clear it, take your vehicle to a dealer. Error Message HEAT ERROR Cause High Temperature FORMAT BAD DISC PLEASE CHECK OWNER'S MANUAL PUSH EJECT BAD DISC PLEASE CHECK OWNER'S MANUAL Track/File format not supported Mechanical Error Servo Error Solution Will disappear when the temperature returns to normal. Current track will be skipped. The next supported track or file plays automatically. Press the EJECT button and pull out the disc(s). Check the disc for serious damage, signs of deformation, excessive scratches, and/or dirt (see page 207). Insert the disc again. If the code does not disappear, or the disc(s) cannot be removed, consult your dealer. Do not try to force the disc out the player. 128 Optional Disc Changer Error Messages (Models without navigation system) The chart on the right explains the error messages you may see in the display while playing a disc. If you see an error message in the display while playing a disc, press the eject button. After ejecting the disc, check it for damage or deformation. If there is no damage, insert the disc again. If there is still a problem, the error message will appear again. Press the eject button, and pull out the disc. Insert a different disc. If the new disc plays, there is a problem with the first disc. If the error message cycle repeats and you cannot clear it, take your vehicle to a dealer. Error Message Cause FOCUS Error No disc in the disc magazine Mechanical Error No disc magazine in the disc changer High Temperature Solution Press the magazine eject button, and pull the magazine out. If the message does not disappear or the magazine cannot be pulled out, see your dealer. Insert disc. Press the magazine eject button, pull the magazine out, check for an error message, then insert the magazine again. If the message does not disappear, or the magazine cannot be pulled out, see your dealer. Insert disc magazine. Will disappear when the temperature returns to normal. Features 129 Playing an iPod (Models without navigation system) iPod INDICATOR CD BUTTON DISP (DISPLAY) BUTTON AUX BUTTON 130 RPT (REPEAT) BUTTON TUNE KNOB SEEK/SKIP BUTTON POWER/VOLUME KNOB RDM (RANDOM) BUTTON Playing an iPod (Models without navigation system) To Play an iPod This audio system can select and play the audio files on the iPod with the same controls used for the disc player. To play an iPod, connect it to the USB adapter cable in the console compartment by using your dock connector, then press the AUX button. The ignition switch must be in the ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position. The iPod will also be charged with the ignition switch in these positions. The audio system reads and plays sound files to be playable on the iPod. The system cannot operate an iPod as a mass storage device. The system will only play songs stored on the iPod with iTunes. iPod and iTunes are registered trademarks owned by Apple Inc. iPods that are compatible with your audio system are listed below. Model iPod 5G iPod classic iPod nano iPod nano 2nd generation iPod nano 3rd generation iPod touch iPhone Firmware Ver. 1.2 or more Ver. 1.0 or more Ver. 1.2 or more Ver. 1.1.2 or more Ver. 1.0 or more Ver. 1.1.1 or more Ver. 1.1.1 or more : Use the latest firmware. Use only compatible iPods with the latest firmware. iPods that are not compatible will not work in this audio unit. Features CONTINUED 131 Playing an iPod (Models without navigation system) NOTE: Do not connect your iPod using a hub. Do not keep the iPod in the vehicle. Direct sunlight and high heat will damage it. Do not use an extension cable between the USB adapter cable equipped with your vehicle and your dock connector. We recommend backing up your data before playing it. In AAC format, DRM (digital rights management) files cannot be played. If the system finds a DRM file, the audio unit displays UNPLAYABLE, and then skips to the next file. Connecting an iPod USB CONNECTOR CABLE 1. Pull out the USB connector from the holder and remove the cable from the clip in the console compartment. USB ADAPTER CABLE DOCK CONNECTOR 2. Connect your dock connector to the iPod correctly and securely. 3. Install the dock connector to the USB adapter cable securely. 132 Features Playing an iPod (Models without navigation system) Sample Display OK to disconnect. When the iPod is connected and the iPod mode is selected on the audio display, ``USB LOAD'' is shown for a few seconds, then the iPod indicator is shown in the display. In the radio or disc mode, the display shows a ``USB CONNECTED'' message for a few seconds. After loading, you will see the Honda mark on the iPod. That means you can only operate your iPod with the vehicle's audio unit. : It may take a few minutes for the Honda mark to display on the iPod. If the display does not change, this function is not supported on your iPod model or firmware. If the iPod indicator does not appear in the audio display, check the connections, and try to reconnect the iPod a few times. If the audio system still does not recognize the iPod, the iPod may need to be reset. Follow the instructions that came with your iPod, or you can find reset instructions online at www.apple.com/ ipod. Text Data Display Function Each time you press the DISP button, the display mode switches between the album name, the song/track name, the artist name, or name off (which turns off the text display). The display shows up to 16 characters of the selected data. If the text data has more than 16 characters, you will see the first 15 characters and the indicator in the display. Press and hold the DISP button until the next 16 characters are shown. CONTINUED 133 Playing an iPod (Models without navigation system) To Change or Select Files You can use the SEEK/SKIP button while an iPod is playing to select passages and change files. SKIP Each time you press and release the side of the SEEK/ SKIP button, the system skips forward to the beginning of the next file. Press and release the side of the button to skip backward to the beginning of the current file. Press it again to skip to the beginning of the previous file. To move rapidly within a file, press and hold either side ( or ) of the SEEK/SKIP button. To Select a File from iPod Menu Turn the TUNE knob. Push the TUNE knob. You can also select a file from the iPod menu: ALBUM (albums), SONG (songs), P-LIST (playlists), and ARTIST (artists), by using the TUNE knob. Push the TUNE (SOUND) knob to switch the display to an iPod menu, then turn the TUNE knob to select a desired mode. If you stop adjusting, the displayed mode is selected after about five seconds. The system begins to play the first file stored in the selected mode. 134 Playing an iPod (Models without navigation system) For example, with the album mode selected, turn the TUNE knob right or left to select a different album. Turn to the right to skip to the next album, and turn to the left to skip to the previous album. When the album is selected, the system begins to play the first song on that album. With the artist mode, turning the knob selects a different artist. Features Selection within a Mode Turn the TUNE knob to select a different item in the selected mode. The selected item will be shown on the display for a few seconds. When you stop turning, the system begins to play the first file from the selected item. If you select ``ALL,'' all available files on the selected menu (album or artist) are played. If you press and release the TUNE (SOUND) knob repeatedly, the display switches from the iPod menu to the sound settings (see page 115 ). CONTINUED 135 Playing an iPod (Models without navigation system) To Select Repeat or Random Mode: You can select any type of repeat and shuffle modes by using the RPT and RDM buttons. RPT (Repeat one track) This feature continuously plays a file. To activate repeat, press and release the RPT button. You will see RPT in the display. Press the button again to turn it off. Pressing either side of the SEEK/ SKIP button or turning the TUNE knob changes the file while keeping the repeat feature. RDM INDICATOR RDM (All Random) This feature plays all available files in a selected mode (playlists, artists, albums or songs) in random order. To activate this, press and release the RDM button. You will see RDM in the display. F-RDM (Album Random) This feature plays all available albums in a selected mode (playlists, artists, albums or songs) in random order. The files in each album are played in the recorded order. To activate this, press and release the RDM button repeatedly until you see F-RDM in the display. Each time you press and release the RDM button, the mode changes from all random, to album random, then to normal play. Press and hold the button until you hear a beep to turn off either random mode. Pressing either side of the SEEK/ SKIP button or turning the TUNE knob changes a file while keeping the random function. NOTE: Available operating functions vary on models or versions. Some functions may not be available on the vehicle's audio system. 136 Features Playing an iPod (Models without navigation system) To Stop Playing Your iPod To play the radio, press the AM/FM button. Press the CD button to switch to the disc mode (if a disc is loaded). Disconnecting an iPod You can disconnect the iPod at any time when you see the ``OK to disconnect'' message in the iPod display. With the AUX mode, you will see a ``USB NO DATA'' message in the display. Always make sure you see ``OK to disconnect'' in the iPod display before you disconnect it. Make sure to follow the iPod's instructions on how to disconnect the dock connector from the USB adapter cable. iPod Error Messages If you see an error message in the display, see page 138 . : The displayed message may vary on models or versions. On some models, there is no message to disconnect. If you reconnect the same iPod, the system may begin playing where it left off, depending on what mode the iPod is in when it is reconnected. 137 iPod Error Messages (Models without navigation system) If you see an error message on the audio display while playing an iPod, find the solution in the chart to the right. If you cannot clear the error message, take your vehicle to your dealer. Error Message UNSUPPORTED UNSUPPORTED VER Solution The system cannot read the file(s). Check the files in the iPod. There is a possibility that the files have been damaged. Appears when an unsupported iPod is inserted. 138 Playing a USB Flash Memory Device (Models without navigation system) SCAN BUTTON CD BUTTON DISP (DISPLAY) BUTTON AUX BUTTON Features RPT (REPEAT) BUTTON TUNE KNOB SEEK/SKIP BUTTON POWER/VOLUME KNOB RDM (RANDOM) BUTTON 139 Playing a USB Flash Memory Device (Models without navigation system) To Play a USB Flash Memory Device This audio system can select and play the audio files on a USB flash memory device with the same controls used for the disc player. To play a USB flash memory device, connect it to the USB adapter cable in the console compartment, then press the AUX button. The ignition switch must be in the ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position. The audio system reads and plays the audio files on the USB flash memory device in MP3, WMA or AAC formats. The USB flash memory device limit is up to 700 folders or up to 65535 files. : Only AAC format files recorded with iTunes are playable on this audio unit. The recommended USB flash memory devices are 256 Mbyte or higher. Some digital audio players may be compatible as well. Some USB flash memory devices (such as devices with security lockout features, etc.) will not work in this audio unit. NOTE: Do not use a device such as a card reader or hard drive as the device or your files may be damaged. Do not connect your USB flash memory device using a hub. Do not use an extension cable to the USB adapter cable equipped with your vehicle. Do not keep a USB flash memory device in the vehicle. Direct sunlight and high heat will damage it. We recommend backing up your data before playing a USB flash memory device. Depending on the type and number of files, it may take some time before they begin to play. Depending on the software the files were made with, it may not be possible to play some files, or display some text data. 140 Features Playing a USB Flash Memory Device (Models without navigation system) The specifications for compatible MP3 files are: Sampling frequency: 32/44.1/48 kHz (MPEG1) 16/22.05/24 kHz (MPEG2) Bitrate: 32/40/48/56/64/80/96/112/128/ 160/192/224/256/320/VBR kbps (MPEG1) Supported standards: MPEG1 Audio Layer3 MPEG2 Audio Layer3 Partition: Top partition only Maximum layers: 8 The specifications for compatible WMA files are: Sampling frequency: 32/44.1/48 kHz Bitrate: 48320/VBR kbps (Max 384) Supported standards: WMA version 7/8/9 Partition: Top partition only Maximum layers: 8 The specifications for compatible AAC files are: Sampling frequency: 8/11.025/12/16/22.05/24/32/ 44.1/48 kHz Bitrate: 48320 kbps Supported standards: MPEG4/AAC LC MPEG2/AAC LC Partition: Top partition only Maximum layers: 8 Even if recorded in MP3, WMA or AAC format, a file with unsupported version cannot be played. If the system finds it, the audio unit displays UNSUPPORTED, and then skips to the next file. In WMA or AAC format, DRM (digital rights management) files cannot be played. If the system finds a DRM file, the audio unit displays UNPLAYABLE FILE, and then skips to the next file. CONTINUED 141 Playing a USB Flash Memory Device (Models without navigation system) Connecting a USB Flash Memory Device USB CONNECTOR CABLE 1. Pull out the USB connector from the holder and remove the cable from the clip in the console compartment. USB ADAPTER CABLE 2. Connect the USB flash memory device to the USB adapter cable correctly and securely. When the USB flash memory device is connected, the display shows a ``USB CONNECTED'' message for a few seconds. If the AUX mode is selected, a ``USB LOAD'' message is displayed for a few seconds. When the USB flash memory device is connected, the USB indicator is shown in the display. Text Data Display Function Each time you press the DISP button, the display mode shows you in sequence, the folder name, the file name, the artist tag, the album tag, the track tag and name off (which turns off the text display). The display shows up to 16 characters of the selected data. If the text data has more than 16 characters, you will see the first 15 characters and the indicator in the display. Press and hold the DISP button until the next 16 characters are shown. 142 Features Playing a USB Flash Memory Device (Models without navigation system) To Change or Select Files Use the SEEK/SKIP button while a USB flash memory device is playing to select passages and change files. SKIP Each time you press and release the side of the SEEK/ SKIP button, the system skips forward to the beginning of the next file. Press and release the side of the button to skip backward to the beginning of the current file. Press it again to skip to the beginning of the previous file. To move rapidly within a file, press and hold either side ( or ) of the SEEK/SKIP button. FOLDER SELECTION To select a different folder, turn the TUNE knob right or left. Turn to the right to skip to the next folder, and turn to the left to skip to the previous folder. Turning the TUNE knob more than two clicks skips several folders. RPT INDICATOR File repeat mode is shown. RPT (File Repeat) This feature continuously plays a file. To activate file repeat, press and release the RPT button (preset 2). You will see RPT in the display. F-RPT (Folder Repeat) This feature replays all the files in the selected folder in the order they are stored. To activate folder repeat, press and release the RPT button (preset 2) repeatedly until you see F-RPT in the display. Each time you press and release the RPT button, the mode changes from file repeat to folder repeat, then to normal play. Press and hold the button until you hear a beep to turn off either repeat mode. Pressing either side of the SEEK/SKIP button also turns off this feature. CONTINUED 143 Playing a USB Flash Memory Device (Models without navigation system) F-RDM (Folder Random) This feature plays the files in the selected folder in random order. To activate folder random, press and release the RDM button (preset 3). You will see F-RDM in the display. RDM (All Random) This feature plays all the files in random order. To activate all random, press and release the RDM button (preset 3) repeatedly until you see RDM in the display. Each time you press and release the RDM button, the mode changes from folder random, to all random, then to normal play. Press and hold the button until you hear a beep to turn off either random mode. SCAN INDICATOR File scan is selected. SCAN (File Scan) This feature samples all files in the selected folder in the order they are stored. To activate the scan, press and release the SCAN button. You will see SCAN in the display. You will get a 10 second sampling of each file in the folder. F-SCAN (Folder Scan) This feature samples the first file in each folder in the order they are stored. To activate folder scan, press and release the SCAN button repeatedly until you see F-SCAN in the display. You will get a 10 second sampling of the first file in each folder. Each time you press and release the SCAN button, the mode changes from file scan, to folder scan, then to normal play. Press and hold the button until you hear a beep to turn off either scan mode. 144 Playing a USB Flash Memory Device (Models without navigation system) To Stop Playing a USB Flash Memory Device To play the radio, press the AM/FM button. Press the CD button to switch to the disc mode (if a disc is loaded). If you reconnect the same USB flash memory device, the system will begin playing where it left off. Disconnecting a USB Flash Memory Device You can disconnect the USB flash memory device at any time even if the USB mode is selected on the audio system. With the AUX mode, you will see a ``USB NO DATA'' message in the display. Make sure to follow the USB flash memory device's instructions when you remove it. USB Flash Memory Device Error Messages If you see an error message in the display, see page 146 . If you reconnect the same USB flash memory device, the system will begin playing where it left off. Features 145 USB Flash Memory Device Error Messages (Models without navigation system) If you see an error message on the audio display while playing a USB flash memory device, find the solution in the chart to the right. If you cannot clear the error message, take your vehicle to your dealer. Error Message UNPLAYABLE FILE UNSUPPORTED Solution The system cannot read the file(s). Check the files in the USB flash memory device. There is a possibility that the files have been damaged. Appears when the unsupported USB flash memory device is inserted. 146 Audio System (Models with navigation system) Voice Control System In addition to the standard audio controls, the audio system in your vehicle can be operated using the voice control system. See the navigation section in your Quick Start Guide for an overview of this system, and the Navigation System Manual for complete details. Playing the AM/FM Radio FM2 ICON FM1 ICON AM ICON AM/FM BUTTON AUDIO BUTTON SCAN BUTTON AUTO SELECT ICON BACKGROUND ICON SOUND ICON Features TUNE BAR U.S. model is shown. PRESET BUTTONS 147 Playing the AM/FM Radio (Models with navigation system) To Play the AM/FM Radio The ignition switch must be in the ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position. Turn the system on by pushing the power/volume knob or the AM/FM button. Adjust the volume by turning the power/volume knob. Pushing the AUDIO button will also turn on the system. You can also operate the audio system without using the control icons on the audio screen. Use the control buttons on the left side of the screen. The status bar appears on the bottom of the screen each time you operate any of the control buttons. On the navigation screen, you can also see audio information by touching the AUDIO INFO icon on the lower of the screen. The band and frequency that the radio was last tuned to are displayed. To change bands, press the AM/FM button, or touch the desired band icon (FM1, FM2, AM, XM1, or XM2). On the FM band, STEREO will be displayed if the station is broadcasting in stereo. Stereo reproduction on AM is not available. U.S. models only For information on XM radio, see page 151 . To Select a Station You can use any of five methods to find radio stations on the selected band: TUNE, SEEK, SCAN, the preset buttons, and AUTO SELECT. TUNE Use the TUNE bar to tune the radio to a desired frequency. Press the side of the bar to tune to a higher frequency, and press the side to tune to a lower frequency. Press and hold the or side of the TUNE bar until you hear two beeps to change the frequency rapidly. Release the bar when the display reaches the desired frequency. 148 Features Playing the AM/FM Radio (Models with navigation system) SEEK The seek function searches up and down from the current frequency to find a station with a strong signal. To activate it, press and hold the or side of the TUNE bar until you hear a beep, then release it. SCAN The scan function samples all stations with strong signals on the selected band. To activate it, press the SCAN button, then release it. You will see SCAN in the display. The system will scan for a station with a strong signal. When it finds one, it will stop and play that station for about 10 seconds. If you do nothing, the system will then scan for the next strong station and play it for 10 seconds. When it plays a station you want to listen to, press the SCAN button again. Preset Each preset button can store one frequency on AM and two frequencies on FM. 1. Select the desired band, AM or FM. FM1 and FM2 let you store six stations each. 2. Use the tune, seek, or scan function to tune the radio to a desired station. Each preset button's frequency is shown on the bottom of the audio display. 3. Pick a preset button, and hold it until you hear a beep. 4. Repeat steps 1 through 3 to store a total of six stations on AM and twelve stations on FM. CONTINUED 149 Playing the AM/FM Radio (Models with navigation system) AUTO SELECT If you are traveling far from home and can no longer receive your preset stations, you can use the auto select feature to find stations in the local area. Press the AUDIO button to view the audio control icons, then touch the AUTO SEL icon. You will see AUTO SEL flashes in the display, and the system goes into scan mode for several seconds. It stores the frequencies of six AM, and twelve FM stations in the preset buttons. You will see a ``0'' displayed after pressing a preset button if auto select cannot find a strong station for every preset button. If you do not like the stations auto select has stored, you can store other frequencies on the preset buttons as previously described. To turn off auto select, press the AUTO SEL icon. This restores the presets you originally set. For information on AM/FM radio frequencies and reception, see page 204 . 150 U.S. models only Playing the XM Radio (Models with navigation system) XM RADIO ICON MODE ICON POWER/VOLUME KNOB AM/FM BUTTON XM RADIO BUTTON AUDIO BUTTON SCAN BUTTON PRESET CHANNEL NUMBER JOYSTICK CATEGORY INDICATOR Features TUNE BAR PRESET BUTTONS 151 Playing the XM Radio (Models with navigation system) Your audio system is capable of receiving XM Radio anywhere in the United States, except Hawaii and Alaska. XM is a registered trademark of XM Satellite Radio , Inc. XM Radio receives signals from two satellites to produce clear, highquality digital reception. It offers many channels in several categories. Along with a large selection of different types of music, XM Radio allows you to view channel and category selections in the display. When you press and hold the AUDIO button, the display also shows all XM information. Operating the XM Radio To listen to XM Radio, turn the ignition switch to the ACCESSORY (I) or the ON (II) position. Push the power/volume knob to turn on the audio system, and press the XM RADIO button. Adjust the volume by turning the knob. The last channel you listened to will show in the display. You can also change to the XM Radio while you are listening to an FM station, AM station, disc, pc card, etc., by touching the XM1 or XM2 icon on the audio display. MODE To switch between channel mode and category mode, touch the MODE icon. In channel mode, you can select all of the available channels. In category mode, such as Jazz, Rock, Classical, etc., you can select all of the channels within that category. Each time you touch and release the MODE icon, the display changes between the channel mode and the category mode. You can also operate the radio using the control buttons on the left side of the screen. The status bar appears on the bottom of the screen each time you press any of the control buttons. On the navigation screen, you can also see the audio information by touching the AUDIO INFO icon on the lower of the screen. 152 Features Playing the XM Radio (Models with navigation system) On the audio display, you will see the selected CHANNEL (number), CATEGORY, NAME (artist name), and TITLE (music title). You may experience periods when XM Radio does not transmit the artist's name and song title information. If this happens, there is nothing wrong with your system. TUNE Press the TUNE bar to change channel selections. Press for higher numbered channels and for lower numbered channels. In the category mode, you can only select channels within that category. CATEGORY Press and hold either side of the TUNE bar ( or ) until you hear a beep to select another category. SCAN The scan function gives you a sampling of all channels while in the channel mode. In the category mode, only the channels within that category are scanned. To activate scan, press the SCAN button or touch the SCAN icon on the screen. The system plays each channel in numerical order for a few seconds, then selects the next channel. When you hear a channel you want to listen to, press the button or touch the icon again. Preset You can store up to 12 preset channels using each preset button or preset icons on the screen. Each preset button or icon stores one channel from the XM1 band and one channel from the XM2 band. To store a channel: 1. Press the XM RADIO button. Either XM1 or XM2 will show in the display. 2. Use the tune, seek, or scan function to tune to a desired channel. In category mode, only channels within that category can be selected. In channel mode, all channels can be selected. 3. Pick the preset button (icon) you want for that channel. Press and hold the button (icon) until you hear a beep. CONTINUED 153 Playing the XM Radio (Models with navigation system) 4. Repeat steps 2 and 3 to store the first six channels. To Select a Channel from List 5. Press the XM RADIO button again or touch the other XM icon (XM1 or XM2) on the audio display. Store the next six channels using steps 2 and 3. Once a channel is stored, press and release the proper preset button (icon) to tune to it. Each preset button's channel is shown on the bottom of the audio display. CHANNEL LIST ICON You can also select a desired channel from the list shown on the screen. Press the AUDIO button to show the audio control display on the navigation screen. Touch the CHANNEL LIST icon to switch the display to the channel list which shows all channels in all categories. Select and touch a desired channel. To scroll through the display, touch the or icon on the side of the screen. To go back to the previous display, touch the Return icon on the screen. 154 Playing the XM Radio (Models with navigation system) To select a desired icon with the joystick, move it in the appropriate direction, then press ENT. XM Radio Display Messages ``LOADING'' XM is loading the audio or program information. ``OFF AIR'' The channel currently selected is no longer broadcasting. ``UPDATING'' The encryption code is being updated. Wait until the encryption code is fully updated. Channels 0 and 1 should still work normally. ``NO SIGNAL'' The signal is currently too weak. Move the vehicle to an area away from tall buildings, and with an unobstructed view of the southern horizon. `` - - - - '' The selected channel number does not exist or is not part of your subscription. ``NO INFO'' This channel has no artist or title information at this time. ``ANTENNA'' There is a problem with the XM antenna. Please consult your dealer. Features CONTINUED 155 Playing the XM Radio (Models with navigation system) Signal may be blocked by mountains or large obstacles to the south. Signal weaker in these areas. SATELLITE The XM satellites are in orbit over the equator; therefore, objects south of the vehicle may cause satellite reception interruptions. To help compensate for this, ground-based repeaters are placed in major metropolitan areas. Satellite signals are more likely to be blocked by tall buildings and mountains the farther north you travel from the equator. Carrying large items on a roof rack can also block the signal. 156 GROUND REPEATER Features Playing the XM Radio (Models with navigation system) Depending on where you drive, you may experience reception problems. Interference can be caused by any of these conditions: Driving on the north side of an east/west mountain road. Driving on the north side of a large commercial truck on an east/west road. Driving in tunnels. Driving on a road beside a vertical wall, steep cliff, or hill to the south of you. Driving on the lower level of a multi-tiered road. Driving on a single lane road alongside dense trees taller than 50 ft. (15 m) to the south of you. Large items carried on a roof rack. There may be other geographic situations that could affect XM Radio reception. As required by the FCC: Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user's authority to operate the equipment. Receiving XM Radio Service If your XM Radio service has expired or you purchased your vehicle from a previous owner, you can listen to a sampling of the broadcasts available on XM Radio. With the ignition switch in the ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position, push the power/volume knob to turn on the audio system and press the XM RADIO button. A variety of music types and styles will play. If you decide to purchase XM Radio service, contact XM Radio at www.xmradio.com, or at 1-800-852-9696. You will need to give them your radio I.D. number and your credit card number. To get your radio I.D. number, press the TUNE bar until ``0'' appears in the display. Your I.D. will appear in the display. After you've registered with XM Radio, keep your audio system in the satellite radio mode while you wait for activation. This should take about 30 minutes. While waiting for activation, make sure your vehicle remains in an open area with good reception. Once your audio system is activated, you'll be able to listen to XM Radio broadcasts. XM Radio will continue to send an activation signal to your vehicle for at least 12 hours from the activation request. If the service has not been activated after 36 hours, contact XM Radio. 157 Adjusting the Sound (Models with navigation system) SOUND ICON You can adjust the sound on the navigation screen. To adjust the sound, push the AUDIO button, then enter the sound grid by touching the SOUND icon on the display. SPEAKER SETTING BASS/TREBLE SETTING BASS Adjusts the bass. TREBLE Adjusts the treble. To adjust the treble and bass, touch or on each side of the treble or bass adjustment bar. The adjustment bar on the right lower display shows you the current setting. FADER Adjusts the front-to-back strength of the sound. To adjust the front/rear fader, touch the FR or RR icon. BALANCE Adjusts the side-toside strength of the sound. To adjust the left/right balance, touch the L or R icon. SUBWOOFER Adjusts the strength of sound from the subwoofer speaker. To adjust the sound strength, touch or on each side of the adjustment bar. The right upper display shows you the current setting of the sound strength coming from each speaker. SVC (speed-sensitive volume compensation) The SVC mode controls the volume based on vehicle speed. The faster you go, the louder the audio volume becomes. As you slow down, the audio volume decreases. Touch the appropriate icon (Low, Mid, Hi, Off) to select the mode. 158 Adjusting the Sound (Models with navigation system) This function is set to MID as the default setting when the vehicle leaves the factory. If you feel the sound is too loud, choose low. If you feel the sound is too quiet, choose Hi. You can also select the icon with the joystick. Move it up and down to move the highlighting and scroll through lists. Select the icon, then move the joystick to left or right to change the setting. Screen Mode You can select the background screen to display the sound level. There are three screen modes: level (the sound level is shown with the vertical bars), spectrum analysis (the sound level appears as ripples of water), and off. Each time you touch the background icon, the display changes. Audio System Lighting You can use the instrument panel brightness control buttons to adjust the illumination of the audio system (see page 75 ). The audio system illuminates when the parking lights are on, even if the radio is off. The system will return to the audio display about 10 seconds after you stop adjusting a mode. Features 159 Playing a Disc (Models with navigation system) POWER/VOLUME KNOB OPEN BUTTON CD BUTTON AUDIO BUTTON SCAN BUTTON TUNE BAR 160 CD ICON JOYSTICK RANDOM BUTTON FAST FORWARD BUTTON SKIPBUTTON REPEAT BUTTON REWIND BUTTON SKIPBUTTON Features Playing a Disc (Models with navigation system) To Play a Disc You operate the disc player with the same controls used for the radio. To load or play discs, the ignition switch must be in the ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position. Do not use discs with adhesive labels. The label can curl up and cause the disc to jam in the unit. This audio system can also play CDRs and CD-RWs compressed in MP3 or WMA formats. When playing a disc in MP3, you will see ``MP3'' on the screen. In WMA format, ``WMA'' will appear on the screen. You can select up to 99 folders and play up to 999 tracks. If the disc has a complex structure, it takes a while to read the disc before the system begins to play it. Video CDs and DVDs do not work in this unit. The specifications for compatible MP3 files are: Sampling frequency: 32/44.1/48 kHz (MPEG1) 16/22.05/24 kHz (MPEG2) Bitrate: 32/40/48/56/64/80/96/112/128/ 160/192/224/256/320 kbps (MPEG1) 8/16/24/32/40/48/56/64/80/96/ 112/128/160 kbps (MPEG2) Compatible with variable bitrate and multi-session Maximum layers (including ROOT): 8 layers The specifications for compatible WMA files are: Sampling frequency: 32/44.1/48 kHz Bitrate: 48/64/80/96/128/160/192 kbps Compatible with variable bitrate and multi-session Maximum layers (including ROOT): 8 layers NOTE: If a file on an MP3 or WMA disc is protected by digital rights management (DRM), the audio unit displays CD FORMAT, and then skips to the next file. CONTINUED 161 Playing a Disc (Models with navigation system) To Load a Disc DISC SLOT OPEN BUTTON The disc player is behind the navigation screen. To use the disc player, press the OPEN button beside the screen. The screen folds back, and the disc player appears. Insert a disc about halfway into the disc slot. The drive will pull the disc in the rest of the way and begin to play it. You cannot load and play 3-inch (8-cm) discs in this system. CLOSE BUTTON To return the screen to the upright position, press the CLOSE button on the edge of the screen panel. Do not use the folded screen as a tray. If you put a cup, for example, on the screen, the liquid inside the cup may spill on the screen when you go over a bump. 162 Features Playing a Disc (Models with navigation system) Push the AUDIO button beside the screen to show the audio display and operate the disc player. To Change or Select Tracks/Files PRESET BUTTON'S FUNCTION You can also operate the audio system without using the control icons on the audio screen. Press the CD button. The status bar appears on the bottom of the screen. On the navigation screen, you can see the audio information whenever you touch the AUDIO INFO icon on the lower portion of the screen. PRESET BUTTONS U.S. model is shown. When playing a CD recorded with text data, the track, album, and artist name are shown on the audio display. When playing a disc in MP3 or WMA, the folder number and name, the file number and name, the artist name, and the elapsed time are shown. The system will continuously play a disc until you change modes. If the disc was not recorded with text data, it will not be displayed. You can use the preset buttons while a disc is playing to select passages and change tracks (files in MP3 or WMA mode). Each preset button's function is shown on the bottom of the screen. You can also select an icon with the joystick. Move it to left, right, up, or down to change the highlighting and scroll through lists. Then press the ENT on the top of the joystick to select the icon. SKIP Each time you press and release (preset 6), the player skips forward to the beginning of the next track (file in MP3 or WMA mode). Press and release (preset 5), to skip backward to the beginning of the current track. Press it again to skip to the beginning of the previous track. FF/REW To move rapidly within a track/file, press and hold (preset 4) or (preset 3). CONTINUED 163 Playing a Disc (Models with navigation system) In MP3 or WMA mode FOLDER SELECTION To select a different folder, press either side of the TUNE bar to move to the beginning of the next folder. Press the side of the TUNE bar to skip to the next folder, and the side to move to the beginning of the current folder. Press it again to skip to the beginning of the previous folder. TRACK REPEAT (FILE REPEAT) To continuously replay a track (file in MP3 or WMA mode), press and release the RPT button (preset 1). You will see TRACK REPEAT in the display. Press and hold the RPT button for 2 seconds to turn it off. In MP3 or WMA mode FOLDER REPEAT This feature, when activated, replays all files in the selected folder in the order they are compressed. To activate folder repeat, press and hold the RPT button (preset 1). You will see FOLDER REPEAT in the display. The system continuously replays the current folder. Press the RPT button again to turn it off. Pressing the RDM button or selecting a different folder with the TUNE bar also turns off folder repeat. TRACK RANDOM (Random within a disc/folder) This feature plays the tracks within a disc (the files within a folder) in random order. To activate track random, press and release the RDM button (preset 2). You will see TRACK RANDOM in the display. Press and hold the RDM button for 2 seconds to return to normal play. In MP3 or WMA mode FOLDER RANDOM This feature, when activated, plays all files in each folder in random order, rather than in the order they are compressed. To activate folder random, press the RDM button (preset 2) twice. You will see FOLDER RANDOM in the display. The system then selects and plays files randomly. This continues until you deactivate folder random by pressing the RDM button again, or if you select a different folder with the TUNE bar. 164 Playing a Disc (Models with navigation system) SCAN (TRACK/FILE SCAN) The scan function samples all tracks (files in MP3 or WMA) in the order they were recorded. To activate scan, press and release the SCAN button. You will see TRACK SCAN in the display. You will get a 10 second sampling of each track/file on the disc. Press and hold the SCAN button for 2 seconds to get out of scan mode and play the last track/ file sampled. Pressing either SKIP button (preset 5 or 6) also turns off scan. In MP3 or WMA mode FOLDER SCAN This feature, when activated, samples all the first files in each folder on the disc in order. To activate folder scan, press and hold the SCAN button. You will see FOLDER SCAN in the display. The system plays the first file in each folder for about 10 seconds. If you do nothing, the system then plays the first file in each folder for 10 seconds each. After playing the first file of the last folder, the system goes to normal play. Pressing either SKIP button (preset 5 or 6), or selecting a different folder with the TUNE bar, or pressing the SCAN button, also turns off folder scan. Using a Track List CD ICON TRACK LIST ICON You can also select a track/file directly from the folder and file lists on the audio display. Press the AUDIO button to show the audio display. Features CONTINUED 165 Playing a Disc (Models with navigation system) FOLDER ICON FOLDER ICON RETURN ICON Touch the Track List icon to switch the display to the folder list, then select and touch a desired folder. FOLDER ICON TRACK/FILE ICON RETURN ICON The display changes to the file list. Then, select and touch a desired file. Touch the folder icon on the upper left of the screen to move to the parent folder. To scroll through the display, touch the or icon on the side of the screen. To go back to the previous display, touch the Return icon on the screen. To select a desired icon with the joystick, move it in the appropriate direction, then press ENT. Press the AUDIO button to go back to the normal audio playing display. Pressing the CANCEL button goes back to the previous screen, and pressing the MAP button cancels the audio control display on the screen. 166 Playing a Disc (Models with navigation system) When playing a CD recorded with text data, each track name is shown on the audio display. With a disc recorded in MP3 or WMA, the folder number is also displayed. If the disc was not recorded with text data, only the track number is shown. To Stop Playing a Disc To play the radio when a disc is playing, press the AM/FM button or touch the FM1, FM2, AM, XM1, or XM2 icon. If a PC card is in the audio unit, touch the CARD icon to play the PC card. Press the CD button again or touch the CD icon to switch back to the disc player. To play an audio unit connected to the auxiliary input jack or the USB adapter cable when a disc is playing, touch the AUX or USB icon. Removing a Disc To remove a disc from the audio unit, fold back the screen by pressing the OPEN button (see page 142 ). Press the disc eject button ( ) to remove the disc. If you eject the disc, but do not remove it from the slot, the system will automatically reload it after 10 seconds and put it in pause mode. To begin playing, press the CD button. To return the screen to the upright position, press the CLOSE button. If you turn the system off while a disc is playing, either with the power/volume knob or by turning off the ignition switch, the disc will stay in the drive. When you turn the system back on, the disc will begin playing where it left off. You cannot close the screen if a disc is partially inserted into its slot. You can also eject the disc when the ignition switch is off. Features 167 Playing a Disc (Models with navigation system) Operating the Optional Disc Changer An optional six or eight disc changer is available for your vehicle. This disc changer uses the same controls used for the in-dash disc player or the radio. Protecting Discs For information on how to handle and protect discs, see page 206 . Load the desired discs in the magazine, and load the magazine in the changer according to the instructions that came with the unit. To select the disc changer, press the CD button. The disc and track numbers will be displayed. To select a different disc, use either side of the TUNE bar. To select the previous disc, press the side. To select the next disc, press the side. If you select an empty slot in the magazine, the changer will search for the next available disc to load and play. 168 Disc Player Error Messages (Models with navigation system) The chart on the right explains the error messages you may see in the display while playing a disc. If you see an error message in the display while playing a disc, press the eject button. After ejecting the disc, check it for damage or deformation. If there is no damage, insert the disc again. If there is still a problem, the error message will appear again. Press the eject button, and pull out the disc. Insert a different disc. If the new disc plays, there is a problem with the first disc. If the error message cycle repeats and you cannot clear it, take your vehicle to a dealer. Error Message Cause FOCUS Error Mechanical Error TOC Error High Temperature Solution Press the eject button, and pull out the disc. Check if it is inserted correctly in the disc player. Make sure the disc is not scratched or damaged. For more information, see page 207. Press the eject button, and pull out the disc. Check the disc for damage or deformation. For more information, see page 207. If the disc cannot be pulled out, or the error message does not disappear after the disc is ejected, see your dealer. Press the eject button, and pull out the disc. Check the disc for damage or deformation. Will disappear when the temperature returns to normal. Features 169 Playing a PC Card (Models with navigation system) POWER/VOLUME KNOB OPEN BUTTON CD/XM BUTTON AUDIO BUTTON SCAN BUTTON TUNE BAR 170 TRACK LIST ICON PC CARD ICON JOYSTICK PLAY MODE ICON RANDOM BUTTON FAST FORWARD BUTTON SKIP BUTTON REPEAT BUTTON REWIND BUTTON SKIP BUTTON Features Playing a PC Card (Models with navigation system) To Play a PC Card You operate the PC card player with the same controls used for the radio and the disc player. To load or play a card, the ignition switch must be in the ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position. The PC card player reads and plays cards in MP3 or WMA formats. Depending on the format, the screen will indicate ``MP3'' or ``WMA'' when a card is playing. The card limit of the player is 99 folders and 999 tracks. If the card has a complex structure, it takes some time for the system to begin playing it. Based on PCMCIA 2.1/JEIDA 4.2, the recommended PC cards for the PC card reader are: CompactFlash Flash ATA SD memory card Always use the recommended memory card with the appropriate adapter (if an adapter is needed). Some memory cards will not work in this unit. NOTE: When you insert a PC card into the slot, make sure you put it in straight. If you cannot insert it, remove it, and insert again. Do not keep PC cards in the vehicle. Direct sunlight and high heat will damage them. To avoid damaging the card reader, do not insert hard disc drive cards into the PC card slot. You cannot close the screen (move it to the upright position) until the PC card is inserted all the way into its slot or removed. Never insert foreign objects into the PC card slot. The specifications for compatible MP3 files are: Sampling frequency: 32/44.1/48 kHz (MPEG1) 16/22.05/24 kHz (MPEG2) Bitrate: 32/40/48/56/64/80/96/112/128/ 160/192/224/256/320 kbps (MPEG1) 8/16/24/32/40/48/56/64/80/96/ 112/128/160 kbps (MPEG2) Compatible with variable bitrate and multi-session Maximum layers (including ROOT): 8 layers CONTINUED 171 Playing a PC Card (Models with navigation system) The specifications for compatible WMA files are: Sampling frequency: 32/44.1/48 kHz Bitrate: 48/64/80/96/128/160/192 kbps Compatible with variable bitrate and multi-session Maximum layers (including ROOT): 8 layers In WMA format, DRM (digital rights management) files cannot be played. If the system finds a DRM file, it skips that file and plays the next available folder or file. Loading a PC Card PC CARD SLOT The PC card slot is behind the navigation screen. To use the PC card player, press the OPEN button beside the screen. The screen folds back, and the PC card slot appears. Insert a PC card straight into the slot. The drive will read the PC card and begin to play it. Return the screen to the upright position by pressing the CLOSE button on the edge of the screen panel. Push the AUDIO button beside the screen to show the audio display and operate the PC card player. You can also operate the audio system without using the control icons on the audio screen. Press any of the appropriate control buttons. The status bar appears on the bottom of the screen. On the navigation screen, you can see the audio information whenever you touch the AUDIO INFO icon on the screen. 172 Features To Select a Play Mode There are three play modes: Folder, Artist, and Album. Touch the PLAY MODE icon, then choose one of the modes by touching its icon. When a mode is selected, it is highlighted in blue. Folder mode plays tracks in the order they were added to the card. Artist mode plays tracks in alphabetical order, by artist and song title. Album mode plays albums (folders) in alphabetical order. If play mode information was not included in the tracks when they were added to the card, it will not be displayed on the screen. To select a play mode, push the AUDIO button to show the audio display, then touch the PLAY MODE icon on the display. Playing a PC Card (Models with navigation system) FOLDER MODE PLAY MODE ICON MODE INDICATOR ARTIST MODE PLAY MODE ICON ALBUM MODE PLAY MODE ICON MODE INDICATOR MODE INDICATOR CONTINUED 173 Playing a PC Card (Models with navigation system) If you select ``Play a New Track List,'' the system goes into the selected play mode immediately and begins to play the files in order to the new list. To go back to the previous screen, press the CANCEL button on the right side of the screen. To exit the play mode screens, press the AUDIO button. Select the desired mode by touching the appropriate icon, or move the joystick, then press the ENT. After you select the play mode, the display changes to the selectable playing menu. If you select ``Continue playing the Current Song,'' the system goes into the selected play mode after playing the current file. 174 Features Playing a PC Card (Models with navigation system) To Change or Select Tracks/Files PRESET BUTTON'S FUNCTION PRESET BUTTONS U.S. model is shown. You can use the preset buttons while a card is playing to select or change files. Each preset button's function is shown on the bottom of the screen. Icons on the screen can also be selected with the joystick. Move the joystick left or right and up or down until the icon is highlighted, then press the ENT on the top of the joystick to select the icon. SKIP Each time you press and release (preset 6), the player skips forward to the beginning of the next file. Press and release (preset 5), to skip backward to the beginning of the current file. Press it again to skip to the beginning of the previous file. FF/REW To move rapidly within a file, press and hold (preset 4) or (preset 3). FOLDER SELECTION To select a different folder, press either side of the TUNE bar to move the beginning of the next folder. Press the side of the TUNE bar to skip the next folder, and to the side to move the beginning of the current folder. Press it again to skip to the beginning of the previous folder. TRACK REPEAT (FILE REPEAT) To continuously replay a file, press and release the RPT button (preset 1). You will see TRACK REPEAT in the display. Press the RPT button again to turn it off. FOLDER/ARTIST/ALBUM REPEAT This feature, when activated, replays all the files in the selected folder/artist/album in the order they are recorded or listed. To activate each repeat mode, press and hold the RPT button (preset 1) for 2 seconds. You will see FOLDER REPEAT, ARTIST REPEAT or ALBUM REPEAT in the display. The system continuously replays the current folder/artist/album. Press and hold the RPT button for 2 seconds again to turn it off. Pressing the RDM button, or selecting a different folder/artist/album with the TUNE bar also turns off the repeat feature. 175 Playing a PC Card (Models with navigation system) TRACK RANDOM (Random within a folder) This feature plays the files within a folder in random order. To activate track random, press and release the RDM button (preset 2). You will see TRACK RANDOM in the display. Press and hold the RDM button for 2 seconds to return to normal play. FOLDER/ARTIST/ALBUM RANDOM This feature, when activated, plays all files in each folder/artist/album in random order, rather than in the order they are recorded or listed. To activate each random play, press the RDM button (preset 2) 2 times. You will see FOLDER RANDOM, ARTIST RANDOM or ALBUM RANDOM in the display. The system then selects and plays files randomly. This continues until you deactivate each random play by pressing the RDM button again, or you select a different folder/artist/ album with the TUNE bar. SCAN The scan function samples all files on the PC card in the order they are recorded. To activate scan, press and release the SCAN button. You will see TRACK SCAN in the display. You will get a 10 second sampling of each file on the PC card. Press and hold the SCAN button for 2 seconds to get out of scan mode and play the last file sampled. Pressing either of the SKIP buttons (preset 5 or 6) also turns off the scan feature. FOLDER/ARTIST/ALBUM SCAN This feature, when activated, samples the first file in each folder/artist/album on the PC card in order. To activate each scan feature, press and hold the SCAN button until you hear a beep. You will see FOLDER SCAN, ARTIST SCAN or ALBUM SCAN in the display. The system plays the first file in the folder for about 10 seconds. If you do nothing, the system plays the first file in each folder, in order, for 10 seconds each. After playing the first file of the last folder/artist/album, the system returns to normal play. Pressing either of the SKIP buttons (preset 5 or 6), selecting a different folder/artist/album with the TUNE bar, or pressing the SCAN button, also turns off the scan feature. 176 Using a Track List Playing a PC Card (Models with navigation system) FOLDER ICON Features TRACK LIST ICON You can also select a file directly from the folder and track lists on the audio display. Press the AUDIO button to show the audio display, then touch the Track List icon. The folder list menu appears on the display. RETURN ICON To scroll through the display, touch the or icon on the side of the screen. To go back to the previous display, touch the Return icon. To select a folder, touch its icon on the screen. The display changes to the file list. Then, select and touch a desired file. In folder mode, touch the folder icon on the upper left of the screen to move to the parent folder. The current folder is highlighted in blue. CONTINUED 177 Playing a PC Card (Models with navigation system) ARTIST NAME ALBUM NAME To select a desired icon with the joystick, move it in the appropriate direction, then press ENT. Press the AUDIO button to go back to the normal audio playing display. Pressing the CANCEL button goes back to the previous screen, and pressing the MAP button cancels the audio control display on the screen. In artist mode, the artist name is also displayed on the right side of each selectable icon. Select the desired file. In album mode, the album name is also displayed on the right side of each selectable icon. Select the desired file. 178 Song Search Function SONG SEARCH ICON Playing a PC Card (Models with navigation system) TITLE BY KEYWORD ICON Searching for a Song Title by Keyword MORE ICON Features Folder mode is shown. RETURN ICON When you select ``Song Search'' from the track list display, the song search menu appears. ARTIST ICON ALBUM ICON You can then select any of three modes to search a file: Title by Keyword, Artist, and Album. DELETE ICON LIST ICON In Title by Keyword mode, enter the title name, or any keyword, by touching the letter icons on the screen. Touch the List icon to begin the song search. If you press the CANCEL button on the screen, the display returns to the mode menu without doing a search. CONTINUED 179 Playing a PC Card (Models with navigation system) To cancel the selected letter, select the letter and touch the Delete icon. To select more characters, touch the More icon. The other character list will be shown. FILE LIST Searching for a Song by Artist Name ARTIST LIST Searching for a Song by Album Name ALBUM LIST Select the Artist icon, and the artist list appears. Select the desired artist, and the artist's file list is displayed. After the system searches for a song, a file list is displayed. To scroll through the list, touch the or icon on the side of the screen. Select the desired file by touching the appropriate icon, or moving the joystick and pressing the ENT. Select the Album icon, and the album list appears. Select the desired album, and its song list is displayed. You can then select the desired song from the list. 180 Features Playing a PC Card (Models with navigation system) To Stop Playing a PC Card To play the radio when a PC card is playing, press the AM/FM button or touch the FM1, FM2, AM, XM1, or XM2 icon. If a disc is in the audio unit, press the CD button or touch the CD icon to play the disc. Touch the CARD icon to switch back to the PC card player. : U.S. models only To play an audio unit connected to the auxiliary input jack or the USB adapter cable when a PC card is playing, touch the AUX or USB icon. If you turn the system off while a PC card is playing, either with the power/volume knob or by turning off the ignition switch, the card will stay in the drive. When you turn the system back on, the card will begin playing where it left off. When you leave the vehicle, always remove the PC card from the audio unit. Removing a PC Card To remove a PC card from the audio unit, fold back the screen by pressing the OPEN button (see page 162 ). Press the eject button ( ) to remove the card. If you do not remove it from the slot, you cannot return the screen to the upright position. To return the screen to the upright position, press the CLOSE button. You can also eject a card when the ignition switch is off. PC Card Player Malfunction If there is a problem with the PC card player, see your dealer. 181 PC Card Error Messages (Models with navigation system) If you see an error message in the display while playing a PC card, find the solution in the chart to the right. If you cannot clear the error message, take your vehicle to your dealer. Indication FILE ERROR NO MUSIC MEDIA ERROR Solution The system cannot read the file(s). Check the files in the disc. There is a possibility that the files have been damaged. It appears when the PC card is empty or there are no MP3 or WMA files in the PC card. Save the MP3 or WMA files in the PC card. It appears when the unsupported PC card is inserted. The system supports CF card, Flash ATA card, and SanDisk 6-in-1 Card Adapter. 182 Playing an iPod (Models with navigation system) POWER/VOLUME KNOB iPod INDICATOR CD/XM BUTTON AUDIO BUTTON USB ICON JOYSTICK AUDIO DISPLAY MAP BUTTON CANCEL BUTTON Features U.S. model is shown. RPT (REPEAT) BUTTON RDM (RANDOM) BUTTON FAST FORWARD BUTTON SKIP BUTTON REWIND BUTTON SKIP BUTTON 183 Playing an iPod (Models with navigation system) To Play an iPod This audio system can select and play the audio files on the iPod with the same controls used for the indash disc player. To play an iPod, connect it to the USB adapter cable in the console compartment by using your dock connector. Press the AUDIO button beside the screen to show the audio display and touch the AUX icon. The ignition switch must be in the ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position. The iPod will also be recharged with the ignition switch in these positions. You can also select an icon by moving the joystick. Move it to left, right, up, or down to change the highlighting and scroll through lists, then press ENT on the top of the joystick to set your selection. To select the USB mode without using the icon, press the CD/XM button repeatedly. The status bar appears on the bottom of the screen. The audio system reads and plays sound files to be playable on the iPod. The system cannot operate an iPod as a mass storage device. The system will only play songs stored on the iPod with iTunes. iPod and iTunes are registered trademarks owned by Apple Inc. Voice Control System You can select the AUX mode by using the navigation system voice control buttons, but cannot operate the play mode functions. iPods that are compatible with your audio system are listed below. Model iPod 5G iPod classic iPod nano iPod nano 2nd generation iPod nano 3rd generation iPod touch iPhone Firmware Ver. 1.2 or more Ver. 1.0 or more Ver. 1.2 or more Ver. 1.1.2 or more Ver. 1.0 or more Ver. 1.1.1 or more Ver. 1.1.1 or more : Use the latest firmware. Use only compatible iPods with the latest firmware. iPods that are not compatible will not work in this audio unit. 184 Playing an iPod (Models with navigation system) NOTE: Do not connect your iPod using a hub. Do not keep the iPod in the vehicle. Direct sunlight and high heat will damage it. Do not use an extension cable between the USB adapter cable equipped with your vehicle and your dock connector. We recommend backing up your data before playing it. In AAC format, DRM (digital rights management) files cannot be played. If the system finds a DRM file, the audio unit displays UNPLAYABLE, and then skips to the next file. Connecting an iPod USB CONNECTOR CABLE 1. Pull out the USB connector from the holder and remove the cable from the clip in the console compartment. USB ADAPTER CABLE DOCK CONNECTOR 2. Connect your dock connector to the iPod correctly and securely. 3. Install the dock connector to the USB adapter cable securely. Features CONTINUED 185 Playing an iPod (Models with navigation system) Sample Display OK to disconnect. When the iPod is connected and the USB mode is selected on the audio display, ``LOAD'' is shown for a few seconds, then the iPod indicator is shown on the display. On the navigation map display, the ``USB CONNECTED'' message will be displayed for a few seconds in the lower part of the screen. After loading, you will see Honda mark on the iPod. That means you can only operate your iPod with the vehicle's audio unit. : It may take a few minutes for the Honda mark to display on the iPod. If the display does not change, this function is not supported on your iPod model or firmware. If the iPod indicator does not appear in the audio display, check the connections, and try to reconnect the iPod a few times. If the audio system still does not recognize the iPod, the iPod may need to be reset. Follow the instructions that came with your iPod, or you can find reset instructions online at www.apple.com/ ipod. When the iPod is connected and the audio display is selected on the screen by pressing the AUDIO button, the AUX icon switches to the USB icon. The display also shows the current file number and total of the selected playable files, the artist, album and track (file) names on the navigation screen. AUDIO INFO ICON On the map screen, you can see the audio information whenever you touch the AUDIO INFO icon on the lower part of the screen. 186 Playing an iPod (Models with navigation system) To Change or Select Files PRESET BUTTONS U.S. model is shown. Use the preset buttons while an iPod is playing to select passages and change files. Each preset button's function is shown on the bottom of the screen. SKIP Each time you press and release (preset 6), the player skips forward to the beginning of the next file. Press and release (preset 5), to skip backward to the beginning of the current file. Press it again to skip to the beginning of the previous file. FF/REW To move rapidly within a file, press and hold (preset 4) or (preset 3). Using a Track List AUDIO DISPLAY TRACK LIST ICON U.S. model is shown. You can also select a file directly from a track list on the audio display. Press the AUDIO button to show the audio display, then touch the Track List icon. The track list menu appears on the display. Features CONTINUED 187 Playing an iPod (Models with navigation system) To scroll through the display, touch the or icon on the side of the screen. To go back to the previous display, touch the Return icon. To select a desired icon with the joystick, move it in the appropriate direction, then press ENT. To Select a File from iPod Menu iPod MENU ICON U.S. model is shown. You can also select a file from the iPod menu: playlists, artists, albums and songs. Press the AUDIO button to display the audio display on the navigation screen. Touch the iPod MENU icon to display the iPod menu. Select a desired list by touching the appropriate icon. 188 Playing an iPod (Models with navigation system) The display shows the items on that list. Touch a desired file. To scroll through the display, touch the or icon on the side of the screen. To go back to the previous display, touch the Return icon. To select a desired icon with the joystick, move it in the appropriate direction, then press ENT. If you select ``ALL'' on either the artists or albums list, all available files on the selected list are played. Press the AUDIO button to go back to the normal audio playing display. Pressing the CANCEL button goes back to the previous screen, and pressing the MAP button cancels the audio display on the screen. To Select Repeat or Random Mode: You can select any type of repeat and random modes with the RPT and RDM buttons. To confirm the selected mode, press the AUDIO button to show the audio display on the navigation screen. Features CONTINUED 189 Playing an iPod (Models with navigation system) U.S. model is shown. TRACK REPEAT This feature continuously plays a track/file. To activate track repeat, press and release the RPT button (preset 1). You will see REPEAT in the display. To turn it off, press and release the RPT button again. Each time you press and release the RPT button, the mode changes between track repeat and normal play. Pressing either SKIP button changes the file while keeping this feature. U.S. model is shown. TRACK RANDOM This feature plays all available tracks/files from the selected items in the iPod menu list (playlists, artists, albums or songs) in random order. To activate track random, press and release the RDM button (preset 2). You will see TRACK RANDOM on the screen. ALBUM RANDOM This feature plays all available albums from the selected items in the iPod menu list (playlists, artists, albums or songs) in random order. The files in each album are played in the recorded order. To activate the album random feature, press and hold the RDM button (Preset 2). You will see ``ALBUM RANDOM'' in the display. To turn it off, press and hold the RDM button (Preset 2). You can also select another list from the iPod menu while keeping the random function. NOTE: Available operating functions vary on models or versions. Some functions may not be available on the vehicle's audio system. 190 Features Playing an iPod (Models with navigation system) To Stop Playing Your iPod To play the radio, press the AM/FM button or touch the FM1, FM2, AM, XM1, or XM2 icon. Press the CD icon to switch to the disc mode (if a disc is loaded). Each time you press the CD/XM button, the audio mode switches between iPod, disc and XM radio. : U.S. models only If a PC card is in the audio unit, touch the CARD icon to play the PC card. Disconnecting an iPod You can disconnect the iPod at any time when you see the ``OK to disconnect'' message in the iPod display. Always make sure you see the ``OK to disconnect'' message in the iPod display before you disconnect it. Make sure to follow the iPod's instructions on how to disconnect the dock connector from the USB adapter cable. : The displayed message may vary on models or versions. On some models, there is no message to disconnect. When you disconnect the iPod while it is playing, the audio screen (if selected) shows NO DATA. If you reconnect the same iPod, the system may begin playing where it left off, depending on what mode the iPod is in when it is reconnected. iPod Error Messages If you see an error message in the screen, see page 192 . 191 iPod Error Messages (Models with navigation system) If you see an error message on the screen while playing an iPod, find the solution in the chart to the right. If you cannot clear the error message, take your vehicle to your dealer. Error Message UNSUPPORTED NO SONG Solution Appears when an unsupported iPod is inserted. There is no music information. 192 Playing a USB Flash Memory Device (Models with navigation system) Features POWER/VOLUME KNOB MP3 INDICATOR AUDIO BUTTON SCAN BUTTON TUNE BAR USB ICON JOYSTICK TRACK LIST ICON SOUND ICON U. S. model is shown. RPT (REPEAT) BUTTON RDM (RANDOM) BUTTON FAST FORWARD BUTTON SKIP BUTTON REWIND BUTTON TUNE BAR SKIP BUTTON 193 Playing a USB Flash Memory Device (Models with navigation system) To Play a USB Flash Memory Device This audio system can select and play the audio files from a USB flash memory device with the same controls used for the in-dash disc player. To play a USB flash memory device, connect it to the USB adapter cable in the console compartment. The ignition switch must be in the ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position. Press the AUDIO button beside the screen to show the audio display and touch the AUX icon. You can also select an icon by moving the joystick. Move it to left, right, up, or down to change the highlighting and scroll through lists, then press ENT on the top of the joystick to set your selection. To select the USB mode without using the icon, press the CD/XM button repeatedly. The status bar appears on the bottom of the screen. The audio system reads and plays the audio files on the USB flash memory device in MP3, WMA or AAC formats. Depending on the format, the display shows MP3, WMA or AAC when a USB flash memory device is playing. The USB flash memory device limit is up to 700 folders or up to 65535 files. : Only AAC format files recorded with iTunes are playable on this audio unit. The recommended USB flash memory devices are 256 Mbyte or higher. Some digital audio players may be compatible as well. Some USB flash memory devices (such as devices with security lockout features, etc.) will not work in this audio unit. 194 Playing a USB Flash Memory Device (Models with navigation system) NOTE: Do not use a device such as a card reader or hard drive as the device or your files may be damaged. Do not connect your USB flash memory device using a hub. Do not use an extension cable to the USB adapter cable equipped with your vehicle. Do not keep a USB flash memory device in the vehicle. Direct sunlight and high heat will damage it. We recommend backing up your data before playing a USB flash memory device. Depending on the type and number of files, it may take some time before they begin to play. Depending on the software the files were made with, it may not be possible to play some files, or display some text data. Voice Control System You can select the AUX mode by using the navigation system voice control buttons, but cannot operate the play mode functions. The specifications for compatible MP3 files are: Sampling frequency: 32/44.1/48 kHz (MPEG1) 16/22.05/24 kHz (MPEG2) Bitrate: 32/40/48/56/64/80/96/112/128/ 160/192/224/256/320/VBR kbps (MPEG1) Supported standards: MPEG1 Audio Layer3 MPEG2 Audio Layer3 Partition: Top partition only Maximum layers: 8 Features CONTINUED 195 Playing a USB Flash Memory Device (Models with navigation system) The specifications for compatible WMA files are: Sampling frequency: 32/44.1/48 kHz Bitrate: 48320/VBR kbps (Max 384) Supported standards: WMA version 7/8/9 Partition: Top partition only Maximum layers: 8 The specifications for compatible AAC files are: Sampling frequency: 8/11.025/12/16/22.05/24/32/ 44.1/48 kHz Bitrate: 48320 kbps Supported standards: MPEG4/AAC LC MPEG2/AAC LC Partition: Top partition only Maximum layers: 8 Even if recorded in MP3, WMA or AAC format, a file with an unsupported version cannot be played. If the system finds an unsupported file, the screen displays UNSUPPORTED, and then skips to the next file. In WMA or AAC format, DRM (digital rights management) files cannot be played. If the system finds a DRM file, the screen displays UNPLAYABLE FILE, and then skips to the next file. Connecting a USB Flash Memory Device USB CONNECTOR CABLE 1. Pull out the USB connector from the holder and remove the cable from the clip in the console compartment. 196 Playing a USB Flash Memory Device (Models with navigation system) To Change or Select Files Features USB ADAPTER CABLE 2. Connect the USB flash memory device to the USB adapter cable correctly and securely. When the USB device is connected and the audio display is selected on the screen by pressing the AUDIO button, the AUX icon switches to the USB icon. The display also shows the folder and file numbers, and the elapsed time. AUDIO INFO ICON On the map screen, you can see the audio information whenever you touch the AUDIO INFO icon on the lower part of the screen. PRESET BUTTONS U.S. model is shown. Use the preset buttons while a USB flash memory device is playing to select passages and change files. Each preset button's function is shown on the bottom of the screen. CONTINUED 197 Playing a USB Flash Memory Device (Models with navigation system) SKIP Each time you press and release (preset 6), the player skips forward to the beginning of the next file. Press and release (preset 5), to skip backward to the beginning of the current file. Press it again to skip to the beginning of the previous file. FF/REW To move rapidly within a file, press and hold (preset 4) or (preset 3). FOLDER SELECTION To select a different folder, press either side of the TUNE bar. Press the side to skip to the next folder, and press the side to skip to the beginning of the previous folder. To Select a File from Folder and File Lists TRACK LIST ICON U.S. model is shown. You can also select a folder and file from the lists shown on the screen. Press the AUDIO button to show the audio display on the navigation screen. 198 Playing a USB Flash Memory Device (Models with navigation system) FOLDER ICON Touch the Track List icon to switch the display to the folder list, then select and touch a desired folder. FOLDER ICON The display changes to the file list. Then, select and touch a desired file. Touch the folder icon on the upper left of the screen to move to the parent folder. To scroll through the display, touch the or icon on the side of the screen. To go back to the previous display, touch the Return icon. To select a desired icon with the joystick, move it in the appropriate direction, then press ENT. Press the AUDIO button to go back to the normal audio playing display. Pressing the CANCEL button goes back to the previous screen, and pressing the MAP button cancels the audio display on the screen. Features CONTINUED 199 Playing a USB Flash Memory Device (Models with navigation system) To Select Repeat, Random or Scan Mode: You can select any type of repeat, random and scan modes with the RPT, RDM and SCAN buttons. To confirm the selected mode, press the AUDIO button to show the audio control display on the navigation screen. TRACK REPEAT This feature continuously plays a track/file. To activate track repeat, press and release the RPT button (preset 1). You will see TRACK REPEAT in the display. U.S. model is shown. FOLDER REPEAT This feature replays all the tracks/files in the selected folder in the order they are stored. To activate folder repeat, press and hold the RPT button (preset 1) until you see FOLDER REPEAT in the display. Press and hold the button until you hear a beep to turn off either repeat mode. Pressing either side of the TUNE bar also turns off this feature. 200 Playing a USB Flash Memory Device (Models with navigation system) TRACK RANDOM This feature plays all the tracks/files in random order. To activate track random, press and release the RDM button (preset 2). You will see TRACK RANDOM in the display. FOLDER RANDOM This feature plays the tracks/files in the selected folder in random order. To activate folder random, press and hold the RDM button (preset 2) until you see FOLDER RANDOM in the display. Press and hold the button until you hear a beep to turn off either random mode. TRACK SCAN This feature samples all tracks/files in the selected folder in the order they are stored. To activate track scan, press and release the SCAN button. You will see TRACK SCAN in the display. You will get a 10 second sampling of each track/file in the folder. FOLDER-SCAN This feature samples the first track/file in each folder in the order they are stored. To activate folder scan, press and hold the SCAN button until you see FOLDER SCAN in the display. You will get a 10 second sampling of each first track/file in the folder(s). Press and hold the button until you hear a beep to turn off either scan mode. Pressing either SKIP button also turns off this feature. Features 201 Playing a USB Flash Memory Device (Models with navigation system) To Stop Playing a USB Flash Memory Device To play the radio, press the AM/FM button or touch the FM1, FM2, AM, XM1, or XM2 icon. Press the CD icon to switch to the disc mode (if a disc is loaded). Each time you press the CD/XM button, the audio mode switches between the USB, disc and XM radio. : U.S. models only If a PC card is in the audio unit, touch the CARD icon to play the PC card. Disconnecting a USB Flash Memory Device You can disconnect the USB flash memory device at any time even if the USB mode is selected on the audio system. Make sure to follow the USB flash memory device's instructions when you remove it. When you disconnect the USB flash memory device while it is playing, the audio display (if selected) shows NO DATA. If you reconnect the same USB flash memory device, the system will begin playing where it left off. USB Flash Memory Device Error Messages If you see an error message in the screen, see page 203 . 202 USB Flash Memory Device Error Messages (Models with navigation system) If you see an error message on the screen while playing a USB flash memory device, find the solution in the chart to the right. If you cannot clear the error message, take your vehicle to your dealer. Error Message UNPLAYABLE FILE UNSUPPORTED NO SONG Solution The system cannot read the file(s). Check the files in the USB flash memory device. There is a possibility that the files have been damaged. Appears when the unsupported USB flash memory device is inserted. There is no music information. Features 203 AM/FM Radio Reception Radio Frequencies The radio can receive the complete AM and FM bands. Those bands cover these frequencies: AM band: 530 to 1,710 kHz FM band: 87.7 to 107.9 MHz Radio stations on the AM band are assigned frequencies at least 10 kHz apart (530, 540, 550). Stations on the FM band are assigned frequencies at least 0.2 MHz apart (87.9, 88.1, 88.3). Stations must use these exact frequencies. It is fairly common for stations to round-off the frequency in their advertising, so your radio could display a frequency of 100.9 even though the announcer may identify the station as ``FM101.'' Radio Reception How well the radio receives stations is dependent on many factors, such as the distance from the station's transmitter, nearby large objects, and atmospheric conditions. A radio station's signal gets weaker as you get farther away from its transmitter. If you are listening to an AM station, you will notice the sound volume becoming weaker, and the station drifting in and out. If you are listening to an FM station, you will see the stereo indicator flickering off and on as the signal weakens. Eventually, the stereo indicator will go off and the sound will fade completely as you get out of range of the station's signal. Driving very near the transmitter of a station that is broadcasting on a frequency close to the frequency of the station you are listening to can also affect your radio's reception. You may temporarily hear both stations, or hear only the station you are close to. 204 AM/FM Radio Reception Electrical interference from passing vehicles and stationary sources can cause temporary reception problems. As required by the FCC: Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user's authority to operate the equipment. Radio signals, especially on the FM band, are deflected by large objects such as buildings and hills. Your radio then receives both the direct signal from the station's transmitter, and the deflected signal. This causes the sound to distort or flutter. This is a main cause of poor radio reception in city driving. Radio reception can be affected by atmospheric conditions such as thunderstorms, high humidity, and even sunspots. You may be able to receive a distant radio station one day and not receive it the next day because of a change in conditions. Features 205 Protecting Your Discs General Information When using CD-R or CD-RW discs, use only high quality discs labeled for audio use. When recording a CD-R or CD-RW, the recording must be closed for it to be used by the system. Play only standard round discs. Odd-shaped discs may jam in the drive or cause other problems. Handle your discs properly to prevent damage and skipping. Do not use discs with adhesive labels. The label can curl up and cause the disc to jam in the unit. Protecting Discs When a disc is not being played, store it in its case to protect it from dust and other contamination. To prevent warpage, keep discs out of direct sunlight and extreme heat. To clean a disc, use a clean soft cloth. Wipe across the disc from the center to the outside edge. A new disc may be rough on the inner and outer edges. The small plastic pieces causing this roughness can flake off and fall on the recording surface of the disc, causing skipping or other problems. Remove these pieces by rubbing the inner and outer edges with the side of a pencil or pen. Never try to insert foreign objects in the disc player. Handle a disc by its edges; never touch either surface. Do not place stabilizer rings or labels on the disc. These, along with contamination from finger prints, liquids, and felttip pens, can cause the disc to not play properly, or possibly jam in the drive. 206 Protecting Your Discs Additional Information on Recommended Discs The in-dash disc player/changer has a sophisticated and delicate mechanism. If you insert a damaged disc as indicated in this section, it may become stuck inside and damage the audio unit. Examples of these discs are shown to the right: 1. Bubbled, wrinkled, labeled, and excessively thick discs Bubbled/ Wrinkled With Label/ Sticker Using Printer Label Kit Sealed With Plastic Ring 2. Damaged discs 3. Poor quality discs Features Chipped/ Cracked Warped Burrs CONTINUED 207 Protecting Your Discs 4. Small, irregular shaped discs 5. Discs with scratches, dirty discs Recommended discs are printed with the following logo. 3-inch (8-cm) CD Triangle Shape Fingerprints, scratches, etc. CD-R or CD-RW may not play due to the recording conditions. Scratches and fingerprints on the discs may cause the sound to skip. Audio unit may not play the following formats. Can Shape Arrow Shape 208 Radio Theft Protection Your vehicle's audio system will disable itself if it is disconnected from electrical power for any reason. To make it work again, you must enter a specific five-digit code (except for model with navigation system)/four-digit code (model with navigation system) in the preset buttons. Because there are hundreds of number combinations possible from five or four-digits, making the system work without knowing the exact code is nearly impossible. You should have received a card that lists your audio system's code and serial numbers. It is best to store this card in a safe place at home. In addition, you should write the audio system's serial number in this owner's manual. If you lose the card, you must obtain the code number from a dealer. To do this, you will need the system's serial number. If your vehicle's battery is disconnected or goes dead, or the radio fuse is removed, the audio system will disable itself. Use the preset buttons to enter the five-digit code (except for model with navigation system)/four-digit code (model with navigation system). The code is on the radio code card included in your owner's manual kit. When it is entered correctly, the radio will start playing. If you make a mistake entering the code, do not start over; complete the five-digit (except for model with navigation system)/four-digit (model with navigation system) sequence, then enter the correct code. You have 10 tries to enter the correct code. If you are unsuccessful in 10 attempts, you must then leave the system on for 1 hour before trying again. Features 209 Remote Audio Controls CH BUTTON VOL BUTTON MODE BUTTON Three controls for the audio system are mounted in the steering wheel hub. These let you control basic functions without removing your hand from the wheel. The VOL button adjusts the volume up () or down (). Press the top or bottom of the button, hold it until the desired volume is reached, then release it. The MODE button changes the mode. Pressing the button repeatedly selects FM1, FM2, AM, disc (if a disc is loaded), or a PC card (if it is loaded). On models with satellite radio system, you can also select XM radio. If an iPod or a USB flash memory device is plugged into the system, you can also select AUX. If you are listening to the radio, use the CH button to change stations. Each time you press and release the top () of the button, the system goes to the next preset station on the band you are listening to. Press and release the bottom () to go back to the previous station. To activate the seek function, press and hold the top () or bottom () of the CH button until you hear a beep. The system searches up or down from the current frequency to find a station with a strong signal. If you are playing a disc, the system skips to the beginning of the next track (file in MP3 or WMA format) each time you press the top () of the CH button. Press the bottom () to return to the beginning of the current track or file. Press it twice to return to the previous track or file. You will see the track/file number and the elapsed time. If the disc has text data or is compressed in MP3 or WMA, you can also see any other information (track title, file name, folder name, etc.). 210 Features Remote Audio Controls, Auxiliary Input Jack If you are playing a PC card, press the top () of the CH button to advance to the next file. Press the bottom () to go back to the previous file. In MP3 or WMA mode, you can use the seek function to select folders. Press and hold the top () of the CH button until you hear a beep, to skip forward to the first file of the next folder. Press the bottom () to skip backward to the previous folder. When playing a USB flash memory device, you can also use the seek function to skip the folder. To activate this, press and hold either side of the CH button until you hear a beep. If you are playing a USB flash memory device or iPod with the USB adapter cable (if equipped), press and release the top () of the CH button to skip forward to the beginning of the next file. Press the bottom () to skip backward to the beginning to the current file. Press it twice to return to the previous file. Auxiliary Input Jack AUXILIARY INPUT JACK The auxiliary input jack is underneath the accessory power socket on the front panel. The system will accept auxiliary input from standard audio accessories. When a compatible audio unit is connected to the jack, press the AUX button (AUX icon on models with navigation system) to select it. 211 Setting the Clock On models without navigation system To set the time, press the CLOCK button until the displayed time begins to blink, then release the button. CLOCK BUTTON Change the hours by pressing the H (preset 1) button until the numbers advance to the desired time. Change the minutes by pressing the M (preset 2) button until the numbers advance to the desired time. Press the CLOCK button again to enter the set time. You can quickly set the time to the nearest hour. If the displayed time is before the half hour, pressing the CLOCK button until you hear a beep, then pressing the R (preset 3) button sets the clock back to the previous hour. If the displayed time is after the half hour, the clock sets forward to the beginning of the next hour. For example: HOUR BUTTON RESET BUTTON MINUTE BUTTON 1:06 will reset to 1:00 1:52 will reset to 2:00 On models with navigation system The navigation system receives signals from the global positioning system (GPS), and the displayed time is updated automatically by the GPS. Refer to the navigation system manual for how to adjust the time. 212 Features Security System The security system helps to protect your vehicle and valuables from theft. The horn sounds and a combination of headlights (low beam), parking lights, side marker lights, and taillights flash if someone attempts to break into your vehicle or remove the radio. This alarm continues for 2 minutes, then it stops. To reset an activated system before the 2 minutes have elapsed, unlock the driver's door with the key or the remote transmitter. The security system automatically sets 15 seconds after you lock the doors, hood, and trunk. For the system to activate, you must lock the doors from the outside with the key, driver's lock tab, door lock master switch, or remote transmitter. The security system indicator on the instrument panel starts blinking immediately to show you the system is setting itself. SECURITY SYSTEM INDICATOR Once the security system is set, opening any door, the trunk, or the hood without using the key or the remote transmitter will cause it to alarm. It also alarms if the radio is removed from the dashboard or the wiring is cut. With the system set, you can still open the trunk with the master key or the remote transmitter without triggering the alarm. The alarm will sound if the trunk lock is forced, or the trunk is opened with the trunk release handle. The security system will not set if the hood, trunk, or either door is not fully closed. If the system will not set, turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position, and check the indicators on the instrument panel. Close either door or the trunk indicated on the display. Check the hood visually since it is not part of the display, and shut it if necessary. NOTE: To see if the system is set after you exit the vehicle, press the LOCK button on the remote transmitter within 5 seconds. If the system is set, the horn will beep once. Do not attempt to alter this system or add other devices to it. 213 Cruise Control Cruise control allows you to maintain a set speed above 25 mph (40 km/h) without keeping your foot on the accelerator pedal. It should be used for cruising on straight, open highways. It is not recommended for city driving, winding roads, slippery roads, heavy rain, or bad weather. Using the Cruise Control CRUISE BUTTON RES/ACCEL BUTTON CANCEL BUTTON Improper use of the cruise control can lead to a crash. Use the cruise control only when traveling on open highways in good weather. SET/DECEL BUTTON 1. Push the CRUISE button on the steering wheel. The CRUISE MAIN indicator on the instrument panel comes on. 2. Accelerate to the desired cruising speed above 25 mph (40 km/h). 3. Press and release the SET/ DECEL button on the steering wheel. The CRUISE CONTROL indicator on the instrument panel comes on to show the system is now activated. Cruise control may not hold the set speed when you are going up and down hills. If your speed increases going down a hill, use the brakes to slow down. This will cancel cruise control. To resume the set speed, press the RES/ACCEL button. The indicator on the instrument panel will come back on. When climbing a steep hill, the automatic transmission may downshift to hold the set speed. 214 Cruise Control Changing the Set Speed You can increase the set cruising speed in any of these ways: Press and hold the RES/ACCEL button. When you reach the desired cruising speed, release the button. To increase your speed in very small amounts, tap the RES/ ACCEL button. Each time you do this, the vehicle will speed up about 1 mph (1.6 km/h). Push on the accelerator pedal. Accelerate to the desired cruising speed, then press the SET/ DECEL button. You can decrease the set cruising speed in any of these ways: Press and hold the SET/DECEL button. Release the button when you reach the desired speed. To slow down in very small amounts, tap the SET/DECEL button. Each time you do this, your vehicle will slow down about 1 mph (1.6 km/h). Tap the brake pedal lightly with your foot. The CRUISE CONTROL indicator on the instrument panel will go out. When the vehicle slows to the desired speed, press the SET/ DECEL button. Even with the cruise control turned on, you can still use the accelerator pedal to speed up for passing. After completing the pass, take your foot off the accelerator pedal. The vehicle will return to the set cruising speed. Resting your foot on the brake pedal causes cruise control to cancel. Features 215 Cruise Control Canceling Cruise Control CRUISE BUTTON CANCEL BUTTON You can cancel cruise control in any of these ways: Tap the brake pedal. Push the CANCEL button on the steering wheel. Push the CRUISE button on the steering wheel. Resuming the Set Speed When you push the CANCEL button, or tap the brake or clutch pedal, the system will remember the previously set cruising speed. To return to that speed, accelerate to above 25 mph (40 km/h), and then press and release the RES/ACCEL button. The CRUISE CONTROL indicator comes on. The vehicle will accelerate to the same cruising speed as before. Pressing the CRUISE button turns the system off and erases the previous cruising speed. 216 Features Bluetooth HandsFreeLink On models with navigation system Your vehicle is equipped with the Bluetooth HandsFreeLink (HFL). HFL uses Bluetooth technology to link your cell phone to your vehicle. With HFL, you can place and receive calls through your vehicle's audio system, without the distraction of handling your cell phone. To use this feature, you need a Bluetoothcompatible cell phone with the Hands Free Profile. For more information, and a list of compatible cell phones, visit handsfreelink.honda. com, or call (888) 528-7876. In Canada, visit www.honda.ca, or call (888) 9-HONDA-9. The HFL is available in English on U.S. models, and in both English and French on Canadian models. To change the language, see page 251. The voice of HFL is set to female. Here are the main features of HFL. Instructions for using HFL begin on page 221 . Voice Control HFL HFL recognizes simple voice commands, such as phone numbers and names. It uses these commands to automatically dial, receive, and store numbers. For more information on voice control, see Using Voice Control on page 221 . Bluetooth Wireless Technology The Bluetooth name and logos are registered trademarks owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc. and any use of such marks by Honda Motor Co., Ltd. is under license. Other trademarks and trade names are those of their respective owners. Bluetooth is the wireless technology that links your phone to HFL. HFL uses a Class 2 Bluetooth, which means the maximum range between your phone and vehicle is 30 feet (10 meters). To use HFL, your phone must have approved Bluetooth capability along with the Hands Free Profile. This type of phone is available through many phone makers and cellular carriers. You can also find an approved phone by visiting handsfreelink.honda.com, or by calling the HandsFreeLink consumer support at (888) 528-7876. In Canada, visit www.honda.ca, or call (888) 9HONDA-9. 217 Bluetooth HandsFreeLink Incoming/Outgoing Calls With a linked phone, HFL allows you to send and receive calls in your vehicle without holding the phone. Help Assistance The HFL system has a help function to provide instructions for pairing a phone, and give hints on how to operate HFL properly. If your response or command is not correct, or the system cannot recognize a command, the HFL system will give you an appropriate command or play the help prompt. Phonebook HFL can store up to 50 names and phone numbers in its phonebook. With a linked phone, you can then automatically dial any name or number in the phonebook. You can also store the desired number to the HFL phonebook directly from your cell phone using the receive contact function in HFL. Your vehicle's HFL system has the cellular phonebook import function. This allows you to import your cellular phonebook to HFL. Using the navigation system, you can make a call directly and store a desired number in HFL from the list shown on the navigation display. For more information on how to import the phonebook, see page 243 . To make a call, see page 232 . NOTE: Your phone may not have phonebook import function. Visit handsfreelink.honda.com, or call the HandsFreeLink consumer support at (888) 528-7876. In Canada, call (888) 9-HONDA-9. You can see your phone's owner's manual for information. Microphone The HFL microphone is on the ceiling, between the spotlights. The microphone is shared with the navigation system. HFL and the navigation system have separate voice recognition systems. When HFL is in use, a voice command for the navigation system will not be recognized even if you press the navigation Talk button. In this case, you will hear two short beeps, and the HFL system has no prompt. 218 Bluetooth HandsFreeLink Audio System When HFL is in use, the sound comes through the vehicle's front audio system speakers. If the audio system is in use while operating either of the HFL buttons or making a call, HFL overrides the audio system. To change the volume level, use the audio system volume knob or the steering wheel volume controls. HFL Buttons NAVI VOICE CONTROL BUTTONS HFL BACK BUTTON HFL TALK BUTTON To operate HFL, use the HFL Talk and Back buttons on the left side of the steering wheel. NOTE: Ensure that you use the HFL buttons, not the NAVI buttons, to give HFL voice commands. The HFL buttons are used as follows: HFL Talk: This button is used before you give a command, and to answer incoming calls. Press and release the button, then wait for a beep before giving a command. HFL Back: This button is used to end a call, go back to the previous voice control command, and to cancel an operation. Features 219 Bluetooth HandsFreeLink Information Display BLUETOOTH INDICATOR When you are operating HFL, dialing or receiving calls with the audio system in use, you will see the above screen on the navigation display. HFL MESSAGE On the map screen, you will see a ``HFL'' message on the screen. A indicator will also be displayed on the screen if your phone is linked to HFL. 220 Features Bluetooth HandsFreeLink How to Use HFL HFL is operated by the HFL Talk and Back buttons on the left side of the steering wheel. The next few pages provide instructions for all basic features of HFL. NOTE: All phones may not operate identically, and some may cause inconsistent operation of HFL. Using Voice Control Here are some guidelines for using voice control: Adjust the airflow from both the dashboard and side vents so they do not blow against the microphone on the ceiling. Close the windows and the moonroof. To enter a command, press and release the HFL Talk button. After the beep, say your command in a clear, natural tone. Lower the A/C fan speed during voice recognition operation. If the microphone picks up voices other than yours, the system may not interpret your voice commands correctly. If HFL does not recognize a command, its response is ``Pardon.'' If it doesn't recognize the command it plays an appropriate Help prompt. Response time may vary depending on the voice command. To hear a list of available options at any time, press the HFL Talk button, wait for the beep, and say ``Hands free help'' or ``Help.'' When you are at the main menu, you can hear general HFL information such as pairing or setting up the system. Press the HFL Talk button, wait for the beep, and say ``Tutorial.'' Many commands can be spoken together. For example, you can say, ``Dial 123-456-7891.'' To enter a string of numbers in a Call or Dial command, you can say them all at once, or you can separate them in blocks of 3, 4, 7, 10, and 11. To skip a voice prompt, press the HFL Talk button while HFL is speaking. HFL will then begin listening for your next command. CONTINUED 221 Bluetooth HandsFreeLink To go back one step in a command process, say ``Go back,'' or press the HFL Back button. If nothing is said while HFL is listening for a command, HFL will time out and stop its voice recognition, then prompt you with available options or help information. The next time you press the HFL Talk button, HFL begins listening from the point at which it timed out. To end a command sequence at any time, press and hold the HFL Back button, or press and release the HFL Talk button, wait for the beep, and say ``Cancel.'' The next time you press the HFL Talk button, HFL begins from the main menu. When you finish a command sequence, HFL returns to idle. For example, when you store the name ``Eric,'' the HFL system response is ``Eric has been stored.'' The next time you press the HFL Talk button, HFL begins from the main menu. Pairing Your Phone Your Bluetooth compatible phone with Hands Free Profile must be paired to HFL before you can make and receive hands-free calls. To confirm that your phone is Bluetooth compatible, visit handsfreelink.honda.com, or call (888) 528-7876. In Canada, call (888) 9HONDA-9. Your phone retailer should also be able to confirm that your phone is Bluetooth compatible. NOTE: HFL does not allow you to pair your phone if the vehicle is moving. For pairing, your phone must be in its discovery mode (searching for a Bluetooth related device). Up to six phones can be paired to HFL. Your phone's battery may drain faster when it is paired to HFL. The following procedure works for most phones. If you cannot pair your phone to HFL with this procedure, refer to your phone's operating manual, visit handsfreelink.honda.com, call the HandsFreeLink consumer support at (888) 528-7876, or call your phone retailer. In Canada, call (888) 9-HONDA-9. 222 Features Bluetooth HandsFreeLink During the pairing process, turn off any previously paired phones before pairing a new phone. Each time a phone is paired with HFL, the system selects a pairing code randomly or sequentially. You can switch this setting between random mode and fixed mode. To select a pairing code setting between Random and Fixed, re2f2e8r to page . If after three minutes your phone is not ready to pair or a phone is not found, the system will time out and return to idle. To pair your first phone, follow the prompts on the HFL system: 1. Park your vehicle. With your phone on and the ignition switch in the ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position, press and release the Talk button. HFL prompts ``Welcome to Bluetooth HandsFreeLink. This system enables hands-free usage of a mobile phone. Before using this system, a phone needs to be paired or connected with HandsFreeLink. Would you like to pair a phone now? Press the Bluetooth HandsFreeLink Talk button, and after the beep, say Yes, to begin the pairing process, or No, to continue.'' 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, if you say ``Yes.'' HFL responds ``Entering phone set up: pair menu. The pairing process requires operation of your Bluetooth phone. For safety, only perform this function while the vehicle is stopped.'' HFL responds ``For proper system function a compatible Bluetooth phone is required. Please visit the HandsFreeLink website, listed in the owner's manual, for a list of approved phones and other system information. HandsFreeLink is waiting to pair with a Bluetooth phone. From your phone, search for Bluetooth devices and select HandsFreeLink.'' HFL responds ``When prompted by your mobile phone, enter the pairing code: 1234.'' : For example Go to Step 4. CONTINUED 223 Bluetooth HandsFreeLink NOTE: Steps 4 and 5 show a common way to get your phone into its discovery mode (searching for a Bluetooth related device). If these steps do not work on your phone, refer to the phone's operating manual. 3. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, if you say No, HFL responds ``Would you like to hear the Bluetooth HandsFreeLink tutorial now? Press the Talk button and after the beep, say yes to begin the tutorial, or say No to exit HandsFreeLink.'' If you say Yes, HFL will begin the tutorial. Follow the prompts on HFL. 4. Follow the prompts on your phone to get it into its discovery mode. The phone will search for HFL. When it comes up, select HandsFreeLink from the list of options displayed on your phone. 5. When asked by the phone, enter the four-digit code from step 3 into your phone. HFL responds ``HandsFreeLink has connected to a new phone. A name is needed to identify this phone. Press the Talk button and say a name. For example, John's phone.'' 6. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say the name you want to use. For example, say ``John's phone.'' HFL responds ``John's phone has been successfully paired.'' HFL responds ``Would you like to hear the Bluetooth HandsFreeLink tutorial now? Press the Talk button and after the beep, say Yes to begin the tutorial, or say No to exit HandsFreeLink.'' If you press and release the Talk button and say ``Yes,'' HFL begins Tutorial. If you say ``No,'' HFL returns to idle. 224 Bluetooth HandsFreeLink To pair another phone, do this: 1. With your phone on and the ignition switch in the ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position, press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Phone setup.'' HFL responds ``Phone setup options are pair, edit, delete, list, status, next phone, and set pairing code. Press the Talk button and say a command.'' 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Pair.'' 3. Repeat steps 2 through 6 on pages 223 and 224 . To rename a paired phone, do this: 1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Phone setup.'' HFL responds ``Phone setup options are pair, edit, delete, list, status, next phone, and set pairing code. Press the Talk button and say a command.'' 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Edit.'' HFL responds ``Which phone would like to edit? Press the Talk button, and say a name, or say List, to hear the names of the paired phones'' 3. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say the name of the phone you want to rename. For example, say ``John's phone.'' HFL responds ``What is the new name for John's phone? Press the Talk button and say a name.'' 4. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say the new name of the phone. For example, say ``Lisa's phone.'' HFL responds ``The name has been changed.'' With only one paired phone, for example, John's phone, HFL responds ``What is the new name for John's phone?'' Then go to step 4. Features CONTINUED 225 Bluetooth HandsFreeLink To delete a paired phone, do this: 1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Phone setup.'' HFL responds ``Phone setup options are pair, edit, delete, list, status, next phone, and set pairing code. Press the Talk button and say a command.'' 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Delete.'' HFL responds ``Which phone would like to delete? Press the Talk button and say a name, or say list, to hear the names of the paired phone.'' With only one paired phone, for example, John's phone, HFL responds ``Would you like to delete John's phone?'' Then go to step 4. 3. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say the name of the phone you want to delete. For example, say ``John's phone.'' HFL responds ``Would you like to delete John's phone? Press the Talk button and say Yes or No.'' 4. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Yes.'' HFL responds ``Preparing to delete John's phone. Press the Talk button and say Continue; otherwise say Go Back or Cancel.'' 5. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, if you say ``Continue.'' HFL responds ``The phone has been deleted.'' ``Go back'' or ``Cancel'' does not delete the phone. To list all paired phones, do this: 1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Phone setup.'' HFL responds ``Phone setup options are pair, edit, delete, list, status, next phone, and set pairing code. Press the Talk button and say a command.'' 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``List.'' HFL responds by listing the name of each paired phone. When all phones paired to the system have been read, HFL responds ``The entire list has been read.'' 226 Bluetooth HandsFreeLink To find out the status of the phone being used, do this: 1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Phone setup.'' HFL responds ``Phone setup options are pair, edit, delete, list, status, next phone, and set pairing code. Press the Talk button and say a command.'' To change from the currently linked phone to another paired phone, do this: 1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Phone setup.'' HFL responds ``Phone setup options are pair, edit, delete, list, status, next phone, and set pairing code. Press the Talk button and say a command.'' 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Status.'' For example, HFL responds ``John's phone is linked. Battery strength is three bars. Signal strength is five bars, and the phone is roaming.'' Some Phones may not send the status information to the HFL system. 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Next phone.'' HFL responds ``Searching for the next phone.'' The system then disconnects the linked phone and searches for another paired phone. If the system finds it, for example, HFL responds ``Paul's phone is linked.'' If no other phones are found or paired, the first phone remains linked. For example, HFL responds ``No other paired phones were found/have been paired. Returning to John's phone.'' Features CONTINUED 227 Bluetooth HandsFreeLink Setting a Pairing Code When you pair your phone to HFL, the HFL system will automatically select a pairing code at random or in order. You can customize this setting mode between Random and Fixed. If you select the fixed mode, the HFL system will select a pairing code sequentially. To change the setting mode, do this: 1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Phone setup.'' HFL responds ``Phone setup options are pair, edit, delete, list, status, next phone, and set pairing code. Press the Talk button and say a command.'' 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Set Pairing Code.'' HFL responds ``Each time a phone is paired with HandsFreeLink, a pairing code is used for security. This code can be randomly generated by HandsFreeLink, or fixed, which is needed for some Bluetooth devices with a preset pairing code. Would you like to set the pairing code as Random or Fixed?'' 3. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, to select the fixed mode, say ``Fixed.'' HFL responds ``What is the fourdigit number you would like to see as the pairing code? Press the Talk button and say the number.'' 4. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say a desired fourdigit number. For example, say ``1000.'' HFL responds ``1000. Is this correct? Press the Talk button and say Yes or No.'' 5. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, if the number is correct, say ``Yes.'' HFL responds ``HandsFreeLink will use this code when pairing to a Bluetooth device.'' 6. If the number is not correct, say ``No.'' HFL goes back to step 3. 228 Features Bluetooth HandsFreeLink Setting Up the System You can select or change some settings for the HFL system. Here are the settings you can select or change. To do this, make sure your vehicle is parked safely, with your phone on and the ignition switch in the ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position. Setting a security passcode You can set a four-digit security passcode to lock the HFL system for security purposes. If you forget your passcode, you cannot activate HFL. Consult your dealer to cancel the passcode. You can also select a ``System Clear'' command to reset HFL (see page 250 ). Changing a security passcode You can change the security passcode. Selecting the incoming notif ication The incoming notification can be set to a ring tone, a prompt, or no notification. The default setting is a prompt. To set a security passcode, do this: 1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``System setup.'' HFL responds ``System setup options are security, change passcode, call notification, auto transfer, and clear. Press the Talk button and say a command.'' 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Security.'' HFL responds ``Security is disabled. Would you like to enable security? Press the Talk button and say Yes or No.'' 3. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Yes.'' HFL responds ``What is the fourdigit number you would like to set as your security passcode? Press the Talk button and say the number.'' If you say ``No,'' HFL returns to idle. 4. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say the four-digit passcode you want to use. For example, say ``1, 2, 3, 4.'' HFL responds ``1, 2, 3, 4. Is this correct? Press the Talk button and say Yes or No.'' CONTINUED 229 Bluetooth HandsFreeLink 5. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Yes.'' HFL responds ``Security is on. Each time the vehicle is turned on, the passcode will be required to use the system. If you forget this passcode, you must either go to the dealer to have it reset, or clear the entire system using the System Clear command.'' Once a passcode is set, HFL will prompt you for your passcode each time the ignition switch is turned to the ON (II) position and you press the Talk button. You will only be asked for the passcode once per ignition cycle. To enter your passcode, do this; 1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, HFL prompts ``The system is locked. What is the fourdigit passcode?'' 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say your four-digit passcode. For example, say ``1, 2, 3, 4.'' 3. If the passcode is correct, HFL responds ``System is unlocked.'' If the passcode is not correct, please try again according to the HFL's guidance. You can also select a ``System Clear'' command to reset HFL (see page 250 ). To change your security passcode, do this: 1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``System setup.'' HFL responds ``System setup options are security, change passcode, call notification, auto transfer, and clear. Press the Talk button and say a command.'' 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Change passcode.'' HFL responds ``What is the four digit number you would like to see as your security passcode? Press the Talk button and say the number.'' 3. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say your four-digit passcode, for example, say ``1, 2, 3, 4.'' 230 Features Bluetooth HandsFreeLink 4. If the passcode is correct, HFL responds ``1, 2, 3, 4. Is this correct? Press the Talk button and say Yes or No.'' 5. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Yes.'' HFL responds ``Security passcode has been changed.'' To set the incoming notification, do this: 1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``System setup.'' HFL responds ``System setup options are security, change passcode, call notification, auto transfer, and clear. Press the Talk button and say a command.'' 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Call notification.'' HFL responds: ``Would you like the incoming call notification to be a ring tone, a prompt or off?'' If you say, ``Prompt.'' HFL responds ``An incoming call prompt will be used.'' You will hear a ``You have an incoming call.'' prompt when receiving an incoming call. If you say, ``Off,'' no audible notification of an incoming call will be selected. During an incoming call, there is no ring tone or prompt playback. The audio system will still mute, and the HFL message or the HFL notification screen will be displayed. 3. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, for example, say ``Ring tone.'' HFL responds ``A ring tone will be used.'' You will hear a ring tone through the audio speakers to announce an incoming call. 231 Bluetooth HandsFreeLink Making a Call You can make calls using any phone number, or by using a name in the HFL phonebook. You can also redial the last number called. During a call, HFL allows you to talk up to 30 minutes after you remove the key from the ignition switch. Continuing a call without running the engine may discharge and weaken the vehicle's battery. To make a call using a phone number, do this: 1. With your phone on and the ignition switch in the ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position, press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Call'' or ``Dial.'' HFL responds ``What name or number would you like to call/ dial? Press the Talk button and say a name, a number, or say list to hear the phonebook entries.'' 3. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Call'' or ``Dial.'' HFL responds ``Calling'' or ``Dialing.'' Once connected, you will hear the person you called through the audio speakers. To change the volume, use the audio system volume knob or the steering wheel volume controls. 4. To end the call, press the Back button. 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say the number you want to call. For example, say ``123 456 7891.'' HFL responds ``123 456 7891. Press the Talk button and continue to add numbers, or say Call or Dial to place a call.'' 232 To make a call from the list shown on the navigation display, do this: Bluetooth HandsFreeLink Features 1. Press the INFO button to show the information screen, then select a ``Cellular Phonebook'' icon. 2. The screen is changed as shown above. 3. Say or select a ``Search Imported Phonebook'' icon. 4. Select a desired phonebook (see page 244 ). 5. Select a name from the list on the screen. The ``Select a number to call'' screen is displayed. 6. Select the desired number from the list to store it in HFL. 7. The ``Select a number to store'' screen is displayed. Select a desired number to call. CONTINUED 233 Bluetooth HandsFreeLink 8. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Call.'' HFL responds ``Dialing the number received from the navigation system. To end the call, please press the Bluetooth HandsFreeLink Back button on the steering wheel.'' To make a call using a name in the HFL phonebook, do this: 1. With your phone on and the ignition switch in the ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position, press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Call'' or ``Dial.'' HFL responds ``What name or number would you like to call/ dial? Press the Talk button and say a name, a number, or say list to hear the phonebook entries.'' 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say the name you want to call. For example, say ``John.'' HFL responds ``Would you like to call John? Press the Talk button and say Yes or No.'' 3. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Yes.'' HFL responds ``Calling'' or ``Dialing.'' Once connected, you will hear the person you called through the audio speakers. To change the volume, use the audio system volume knob or the steering wheel volume controls. 4. To end the call, press the Back button. To redial the last number called by the phone, do this: Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Redial.'' HFL responds ``Redialing.'' Once connected, you will hear the person you called through the audio speakers. To change the volume, use the audio system volume knob or the steering wheel volume controls. 234 Bluetooth HandsFreeLink Sending Numbers or Names During a Call HFL allows you to send numbers or names during a call. This is useful when you call a menu-driven phone system. You can also program account numbers into the HFL phonebook for easy retrieval during menu-driven calls. To send a number during a call, do this: 1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Send.'' HFL responds ``What name or number would you like to send?'' 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say the number you want to send. For example, say ``1, 2, 3.'' HFL responds ``1, 2, 3. Press the Talk button and continue to add numbers or say send.'' NOTE: To send a pound (), say ``pound.'' To send a star (*), say ``star.'' 3. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Send.'' The dial tones will be sent, and the call will continue. To send a name during a call, do this: 1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Send.'' HFL responds ``What name or number would you like to send?'' 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say the name you want to send. For example, say ``Account number.'' HFL responds ``Would you like to send account number? Press the Talk button and say Yes or No.'' 3. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Yes.'' The dial tones will be sent, and the call will continue. Features 235 Bluetooth HandsFreeLink Receiving a Call If you receive a call when you are not on the phone, HFL interrupts the audio system (if it is on), and plays the incoming call notification, if activated. To answer the call, press the Talk button and begin speaking. If you don't want to answer the call, press the Back button. If your phone has call waiting, and you receive a call when you are on the phone, press and release the Talk button to answer it. When you do this, the original call is placed on hold. To return to the original call, press the Talk button again. If you don't want to answer the new call, disregard it, and continue with your original call. If you want to hang up the original call and answer the new call, press the Back button. Transferring a Call You can transfer a call from HFL to your phone, or from your phone to HFL. To transfer a call from HFL to your phone, or from your phone to HFL, do this: Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Transfer.'' The audio switches between HFL and the phone. Automatic Transferring This function allows you to transfer a call automatically to the HFL system. If you get into the vehicle while you are on the phone, a call will be transferred automatically to the HFL system when you turn the ignition switch to the ACCESSORY (I) position. With this function activated, you can also make a call by dialing with the number keys on the phone which has been paired to the HFL system. The automatic transferring function can be set to on or off. 236 Features Bluetooth HandsFreeLink To activate this function, do this: 1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``System setup.'' HFL responds ``System setup options are security, change passcode, call notification, auto transfer, and clear. Press the Talk button and say a command.'' 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Auto transfer.'' If this feature is set to off, HFL responds ``Auto transfer is disabled. Calls dialed on the phone do not automatically transfer to Bluetooth HandsFreeLink. Would you like to enable Auto Transfer? Press the Talk button and say Yes or No.'' Press the Talk button and say Yes or No.'' 3. If the setting changes from off to on, press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Yes.'' HFL responds ``Auto transfer is enabled.'' When you make a call directly from the phone with the auto transfer on, make sure to stop your vehicle safely. To end the call, press the Back button. NOTE: Never try to dial from your phone directly if the vehicle is moving. Muting a Call During a call, you can mute or unmute your voice to the person you are talking to. To mute your voice, do this: Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Mute.'' HFL responds ``Mute is active.'' To unmute your voice, do this: Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Mute.'' HFL responds ``Mute is canceled.'' If this feature is set to on, HFL responds ``Auto-transfer is enabled. Calls dialed on the phone will be automatically transferred to Bluetooth HandsFreeLink. Would you like to disable Auto Transfer? If the setting changes from on to off, HFL responds ``Auto transfer is disabled. Use the Transfer command at the HandsFree main menu to manually transfer calls dialed on the phone.'' 237 Bluetooth HandsFreeLink Setting Up the Phonebook The HFL phonebook can store up to 50 names with their associated numbers. These can be any types of numbers. For example, you can store a phone number and use it to make a call, or you can store an account number and use it during a call to a menu-driven phone system. To add a name, do this: 1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Phonebook.'' HFL responds ``Phonebook options are store, edit, delete, receive contact, and list. Press the Talk button and say a command.'' 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Store.'' HFL responds ``What name would you like to store? Press the Talk button and say a name.'' 3. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say the name you would like to store. For example, say ``John Smith.'' HFL responds ``What is the number for John Smith? Press the Talk button and say the number.'' You can also say an account number instead of John Smith. 4. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say the number. For example, say ``123 456 7891.'' HFL responds ``123 456 7891. Press the Talk button and continue to add numbers or say Enter.'' NOTE: Avoid using duplicate name entries. Avoid using ``home'' as a name entry. HFL will be able to better recognize multisyllabic name entries (``Peter'' instead of ``Pete''), or using a longer name (``John Smith'' instead of ``John''). Use a consistent, even tone and reduce background noise when storing names, as the HFL voice recognition can be sensitive. 5. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Enter.'' HFL responds ``John Smith has been stored.'' 238 Features Bluetooth HandsFreeLink To edit the number of a name, do this: 1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Phonebook.'' HFL responds ``Phonebook options are store, edit, delete, receive contact, and list. Press the Talk button and say a command.'' 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Edit.'' HFL responds ``What name would you like to edit? Press the Talk button and say a name or say list to hear the phonebook entries.'' If only one number is stored, HFL responds ``What is the new number for Eric?'' Then go to step 4. 3. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say the name you would like to edit. For example, say ``Eric.'' HFL responds ``What is the new number for Eric? Press the Talk button and say the number.'' 4. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say the new number for Eric. For example, say ``987 654 3219.'' HFL responds ``987 654 3219. Press the Talk button and continue to add numbers or say enter.'' 5. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Enter.'' HFL responds ``The number has been changed.'' To delete a name, do this: 1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Phonebook.'' HFL responds ``Phonebook options are store, edit, delete, receive contact, and list. Press the Talk button and say a command.'' 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Delete.'' HFL responds ``What name would you like to delete? Press the Talk button and say a name or say list to hear the phonebook entries.'' 3. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say the name you would like to delete. For example, say ``Eric.'' HFL responds ``Would you like to delete Eric? Press the Talk button and say Yes or No.'' CONTINUED 239 Bluetooth HandsFreeLink 4. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Yes.'' HFL responds ``The name has been deleted.'' To list all names in the phonebook, do this: 1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Phonebook.'' HFL responds ``Phonebook options are store, edit, delete, receive contact, and list. Press the Talk button and say a command.'' 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``List.'' HFL responds by listing the names in the phonebook in the order which they were stored. After all names are listed, HFL responds ``The entire list has been read.'' To call a name from the phonebook list, do this: 1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Phonebook.'' HFL responds ``Phonebook options are store, edit, delete, receive contact, and list. Press the Talk button and say a command.'' 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``List.'' HFL responds by listing the names in the phonebook. When it says the name you want to call, for example, Eric, press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Call.'' HFL responds ``Would you like to call Eric? Press the Talk button and say Yes or No.'' 3. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Yes.'' HFL responds ``Calling.'' Once connected, you will hear the person you called through the audio speakers. To change the volume, use the audio system volume knob or the steering wheel volume controls. 240 Features Bluetooth HandsFreeLink Storing a Phone Number Directly from Your Phone You can store the desired number to the HFL phonebook directly from your cell phone. NOTE: Your phone may not have phonebook import function. Visit handsfreelink.honda.com, or call the HandsFreeLink consumer support at (888) 528-7876. In Canada, call (888) 9-HONDA-9. You can see your phone's owner's manual for information. 1. With your phone on and the ignition switch in the ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position, press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Phonebook.'' HFL responds ``Phonebook options are store, edit, delete, receive contact, and list. Press the Talk button and say a command.'' 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Receive contact.'' HFL responds ``The receive process requires operation of your Bluetooth device. For safety, only perform this function while the vehicle is stopped. HandsFreeLink is now waiting to receive a contact from a Bluetooth device.'' 3. Select a desired number from the list on your phone, and send it via Bluetooth (steps will vary for phone types, follow your phone's operating manual). HFL responds, for example ``2 phone numbers have been received for this contact. What name would you like to store for the mobile number 1234567891? Press the Talk button and say a name or say Discard, to discard this number.'' 4. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say the name you would like to store. For example, say ``Neil at work.'' HFL responds ``Neil at work will be stored. Is this correct? Press the Talk button and say Yes or No.'' 5. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, if you say ``Yes.'' HFL responds ``Neil at work has been stored. Would you like HandsFreeLink to receive another contact? Press the Talk button and say Yes or No.'' Go to step 6. If you say, ``No,'' HFL returns to idle. CONTINUED 241 Bluetooth HandsFreeLink 6. If you want to continue to store any other numbers, press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Yes.'' HFL responds ``HandsFreeLink is now waiting to receive a contact from a Bluetooth device.'' Go back to step 3. Cellular Phonebook Options The cellular phonebook option allows you to store up to 1,000 names and 10,000 phone numbers in the phonebook of Bluetooth HandsFreeLink from your cellular phonebook. The maximum names and numbers to be stored varies on the data size. With HFL, you can then automatically dial any name or number in the phonebook. NOTE: Your phone may not have phonebook import function. Visit handsfreelink.honda.com, or call the HandsFreeLink consumer support at (888) 528-7876. In Canada, call (888) 9-HONDA-9. You can see your phone's owner's manual for information. To use the cellular phonebook with HFL, say or select a ``Cellular Phonebook'' icon from the information screen. The navigation display will change as shown above. If any phonebook is not stored and your phone is not linked to HFL, Cellular Phonebook icon is grayed out. 242 Features Bluetooth HandsFreeLink Search Imported Phonebook: This option allows you to search the phone numbers stored in HFL. When you enter a person's first name or last name, the system will find the number you want and let you make calls. Import Cellular Phonebook: This option allows you to store the phonebook of your cellular phone in HFL. When you link your phone to HFL and select this option, the system will start importing and loading the phonebook. Delete Imported Phonebook: This option allows you to delete the stored phonebook from HFL. When you link your phone to HFL and select this option, the system will automatically delete the phonebook of the linked phone from HFL (see page 247 ). NOTE: Before selling or discarding your vehicle, make sure to delete the imported phonebook data. PIN Number: This option allows you to add, change, or remove a PIN number for any phonebook that has been imported. To import the cellular phonebook You can import the phonebook of your cellular phone into HFL. Link your phone to HFL, and select ``Cellular Phonebook'' from the information screen, then select ``Import Cellular Phonebook'' from the ``Select an option'' screen. When the message ``The import was successful'' is displayed, touch the screen to select ``OK.'' CONTINUED 243 Bluetooth HandsFreeLink To search the imported phonebook IMPORTED PHONEBOOK PIN ICON Select a phonebook from the displayed list. If the phonebook you select has a PIN icon, you will need the four-digit PIN number to access the phonebook. The following screen will appear. NOTE: HFL does not allow you to import your phone if your phone is not paired to HFL. For more information on pairing your cell phone to HFL, see page 222 . IMPORTED DATE You can search the stored number by entering keywords to make calls by using HFL. Select ``Cellular Phonebook'' from the information screen, then select ``Search Imported Phonebook'' from the ``Select an option'' screen. The display will change as shown above. 244 Bluetooth HandsFreeLink The system will display a list of person's names, with the closest match to the name you entered at the top of the list. Features Enter the PIN number. You cannot access a PIN protected phonebook if you do not use the correct PIN number. List ICON Enter the person's first name or last name, using the joystick or touching an appropriate icon. If the system does not find an exact match, say or select ``LIST'' when you finish entering the keyword. CONTINUED 245 Bluetooth HandsFreeLink The following category icons will appear: Preference Fax Home Car Mobile Voice Work Other Pager Up to three category icons are displayed in the left side of the list. These category icons indicate how many numbers are stored for the person. If a name has more than three category icons, ``...'' is displayed. After selecting a person, the system will display a list of the person's phone numbers. Select the desired number from the list to make a call. To store a number in the Bluetooth HandsFreeLink Say or select ``Store in HandsFreeLink'' from the ``Select a number to call'' screen. The screen shown above will appear. Select the desired number from the list to store it in HFL. 246 To delete the imported phonebook Bluetooth HandsFreeLink Select a phonebook from the displayed list. If the phonebook you select has a PIN icon, you will need the four-digit PIN number to access the phonebook. The following screen will appear. After you enter the correct PIN number, or if the phonebook you select is not PIN protected, the following screen appears. Features You can delete the stored phonebook from HFL. Link your phone to HFL and select ``Cellular Phonebook'' from the information screen, then select ``Delete Imported Phonebook'' from the ``Select an option'' screen. The display will change as shown above. Enter the PIN number. You cannot access a PIN protected phonebook if you do not use the correct PIN number. Say or select ``Yes'', and the message ``The imported phonebook has been deleted.'' will appear. Select ``OK'' to complete the deletion. CONTINUED 247 Bluetooth HandsFreeLink To add, change, or remove a PIN number from any phonebook To add a PIN number You can add, change, or remove a PIN number from any phonebook. Select ``Cellular Phonebook'' from the information screen, then select ``PIN Number'' from the ``Select an option'' screen. The display will change as shown above. 1. Select the phonebook you wish to add the PIN number to. When you select the phonebook without a PIN icon, the display will change as shown above. 2. Enter the four-digit PIN number. You will be asked to re-enter the PIN to verify. 248 To change a PIN number Bluetooth HandsFreeLink Features 1. Select the phonebook that you wish to change the PIN number for. The display will change as shown above. 2. Enter your current PIN number. 3. Enter your new four-digit PIN number. You will be asked to reenter the PIN to verify. 249 Bluetooth HandsFreeLink Clearing the System This operation clears the HFL of your passcode, your paired phones, all names in the HFL phonebook, and all imported phonebooks. Clearing is recommended before you sell your vehicle. To clear the system, do this: 1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``System setup.'' HFL responds ``System setup options are security, change passcode, call notification, auto transfer, and clear. Press the Talk button and say a command.'' 3. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Yes.'' HFL responds ``Preparing to clear the system, which may take up to two minutes to complete. To proceed, press the Talk button and say Continue, otherwise say Go Back or Cancel.'' 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Clear.'' HFL responds ``This process will clear all paired phones, clear all entries in the phonebook, clear the security passcode, and restore the defaults in the system setup. Is this what you would like to do? press the Talk button and say yes or no.'' 4. After saying Continue, HFL responds ``Please wait while the system is cleared.'' HFL responds ``The system has been cleared.'' 250 Features Bluetooth HandsFreeLink Changing Language Canadian models only To change language, say a command with the current selected language. The following example is changing the language from English to French. 1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Change language.'' HFL responds ``English or French?'' 2. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``French.'' HFL responds ``Vous avez selectionné Français. Les noms enregistres en mode Anglais ne seron pas accessible en mode Français. Voulez-vous continuer? You have selected French. Name tags that were stored while in English mode will not be accessible in french mode. Would you like to continue? Press the Talk button and say Yes or No.'' 3. Press and release the Talk button. 4. Example for changing name tags: After the beep, say ``Oui'' or ``Yes.'' HFL responds ``Quel est le nom If there are no paired phones Français pour Paul's phone?'' without French name tags, HFL Press and release the Talk button. responds ``Veuillez attendre que le After the beep, say ``Téléphone de système change de langue. Please Paul.'' wait while the language is changed.'' HFL responds ``La langue a été All paired phones missing a French changée.'' name tag are recorded, the HFL system returns to idle. NOTE: If there are paired phones without French name tags, the This process will also be required if following prompts will continue. there are paired phones without English tags when changing from If there are paired phones without French to English. HFL responds French name tags, HFL responds ``For the system to identify phones ``La langue a été changée. Pour que that were paired while in another le système identifie les téléphones language, the phone names need to qui ont été jumelés dans une autre be re-recorded.'' langue, les noms des téléphones doivent etre ré-enregistrés.'' 251 Bluetooth HandsFreeLink Quick Language Selection Canadian models only To select a language quickly, do the following. For example, to change from French to English. 1. Press and release the Talk button. After the beep, say ``Anglais.'' HFL responds ``You have selected English. Name tags that were stored while in French mode will not be accessible in English mode. Would you like to continue? Press the Talk button and say Yes or No.'' If you want to continue, follow steps 3 and 4 on page 251 . As required by the FCC: This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user's authority to operate the equipment. This device complies with Industry Canada Standard RSS-210. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference that may cause undesired operation of the device. 252 Before Driving Before you begin driving your vehicle, you should know what gasoline to use and how to check the levels of important fluids. You also need to know how to properly store luggage or packages. The information in this section will help you. If you plan to add any accessories to your vehicle, please read the information in this section first. Break-in Period .............................. 254 Fuel Recommendation .................. 254 Service Station Procedures .......... 255 Refueling..................................... 255 Opening and Closing the Hood........................................ 256 Oil Check .................................... 257 Engine Coolant Check .............. 258 Fuel Economy ................................ 259 Accessories and Modifications .... 262 Carrying Cargo .............................. 264 Before Driving 253 Break-in Period, Fuel Recommendation Break-in Period Help assure your vehicle's future reliability and performance by paying extra attention to how you drive during the first 600 miles (1,000 km). During this period: Avoid full-throttle starts and rapid acceleration. Do not change the oil until the scheduled maintenance time. Avoid hard braking for the first 200 miles (300 km). You should also follow these recommendations with an overhauled or exchanged engine, or when the brakes are replaced. Fuel Recommendation Your vehicle is designed to operate on unleaded gasoline with a pump octane number of 87 or higher. Use of a lower octane gasoline can cause a persistent, heavy metallic rapping noise that can lead to engine damage. We recommend using quality gasolines containing detergent additives that help prevent fuel system and engine deposits. In addition, in order to maintain good performance, fuel economy, and emissions control, we strongly recommend, in areas where it is available, the use of gasoline that does NOT contain manganese-based fuel additives such as MMT. Use of gasoline with these additives may adversely affect performance, and cause the malfunction indicator lamp on your instrument panel to come on. If this happens, contact your authorized dealer for service. Some gasoline today is blended with oxygenates such as ethanol or MTBE. Your vehicle is designed to operate on oxygenated gasoline containing up to 10% ethanol by volume and up to 15% MTBE by volume. Do not use gasoline containing methanol. If you notice any undesirable operating symptoms, try another service station or switch to another brand of gasoline. For further important fuel-related information, please refer to your Quick Start Guide. 254 Before Driving Service Station Procedures Ref ueling Push 1. Park with the driver's side closest to the service station pump. 2. To open the fuel fill door, push down the lever on the left of the driver's seat. Gasoline is highly flammable and explosive. You can be burned or seriously injured when handling fuel. Stop the engine, and keep heat, sparks, and flame away. Handle fuel only outdoors. Wipe up spills immediately. HOLDER TETHER FUEL FILL CAP 3. Remove the fuel fill cap slowly. You may hear a hissing sound as pressure inside the tank escapes. The fuel fill cap is attached to the fuel filler with a tether. Place the cap in the holder on the fuel fill door. 4. Stop filling the tank after the fuel nozzle automatically clicks off. Do not try to ``top off'' the tank. This leaves some room in the fuel tank for the fuel to expand with temperature changes. If the fuel nozzle keeps clicking off even though the tank is not full, there may be a problem with your vehicle's fuel vapor recovery system. The system helps keep fuel vapor from going into the atmosphere. Try filling at another pump. If this does not fix the problem, consult your dealer. CONTINUED 255 Service Station Procedures 5. Screw the fuel fill cap back on until it clicks at least once. If you do not properly tighten the cap, the malfunction indicator lamp may come on (see page 337 ). You will also see a ``CHECK FUEL CAP'' message on the information display. 6. Push the fuel fill door closed until it latches. Opening and Closing the Hood HOOD RELEASE HANDLE LATCH 1. Park the vehicle, and set the parking brake. Pull the hood release handle located under the lower left corner of the dashboard. The hood will pop up slightly. If the hood latch handle moves stiffly, or if you can open the hood without lifting the handle, the mechanism should be cleaned and lubricated. 2. Put your fingers under the front edge of the hood near the center. Slide your hand to the left until you feel the hood latch handle. Push this handle up to release it. Lift up the hood. 3. Holding the grip, pull the support rod out of its clip. Insert the end into the designated hole in the hood. 256 SUPPORT ROD GRIP Oil Check DIPSTICK Service Station Procedures Before Driving CLIP UPPER MARK LOWER MARK To close the hood, lift it up slightly to remove the support rod from the hole. Put the support rod back into its holding clip. Lower the hood to about a foot (30 cm) above the fender, then let it drop. Make sure it is securely latched. Wait a few minutes after turning the engine off before you check the oil. 1. Remove the dipstick (orange loop). 2. Wipe off the dipstick with a clean cloth or paper towel. 4. Remove the dipstick again, and check the level. It should be between the upper and lower marks. If it is near or below the lower mark, see Adding Engine Oil on page 297 . 3. Insert the dipstick all the way back into its hole. 257 Service Station Procedures Engine Coolant Check RESERVE TANK Refer to Owner's Maintenance Checks on page 294 for information about checking other items on your vehicle. MAX MIN Look at the coolant level in the radiator reserve tank. Make sure it is between the MAX and MIN lines. If it is below the MIN line, see Adding Engine Coolant on page 300 for information on adding the proper coolant. 258 Before Driving Fuel Economy Actual Mileage and EPA Fuel Economy Estimates Comparison. Fuel economy is not a fixed number. It varies based on driving conditions, driving habits and vehicle condition. Therefore, it is not possible for one set of estimates to predict fuel economy precisely for all drivers in all environments. The EPA fuel economy estimates shown in the example to the right are a useful tool for comparison when buying a vehicle. EPA estimates include: City MPG Represents urban driving in a vehicle in light traffic. A range of miles per gallon achieved is also provided. Highway MPG Represents a mixture of rural and interstate driving, in a warmed-up vehicle, typical of longer trips in free-flowing traffic. A range of miles per gallon City MPG Highway MPG Combined Fuel Economy Estimated Annual Fuel Cost (Sample U.S. EPA label shown) achieved is also provided. Combined Fuel Economy Represents a combination of city and highway driving. The scale represents the range of combined fuel economy for other vehicles in the class. Estimated Annual Fuel Cost Provides an estimated annual fuel cost, based on 15,000 miles (20,000 km) per year multiplied by the cost per gallon (based on EPA fuel cost data) divided by the combined fuel economy. For more information on fuel economy ratings and factors that affect fuel economy, visit www. fueleconomy.gov (Canada: Visit www. vehicles.gc.ca) 259 Fuel Economy Fuel Economy Factors The following factors can lower your vehicle's fuel economy: Aggressive driving (hard acceleration and braking) Excessive idling, accelerating and braking in stop-and-go traffic Cold engine operation (engines are more efficient when warmed up) Driving with a heavy load or the air conditioner running Improperly inflated tires Improving Fuel Economy Vehicle Maintenance A properly maintained vehicle maximizes fuel economy. Poor maintenance can significantly reduce fuel economy. Always maintain your vehicle according to the maintenance messages displayed on the multiinformation display (see Owner's Maintenance Checks on page 294 ). For example: Use the recommended viscosity motor oil, displaying the API Certification Seal (see page 297). Maintain proper tire inflation An underinflated tire increases ``rolling resistance,'' which reduces fuel economy. Avoid carrying excess weight in your vehicle It puts a heavier load on the engine, increasing fuel consumption. Keep your vehicle clean In particular, a build-up of snow or mud on your vehicle's underside adds weight and rolling resistance. Frequent cleaning helps your fuel economy. Drive Efficiently Drive moderately Rapid acceleration, abrupt cornering, and hard braking increase fuel consumption. 260 Observe the speed limit Aerodynamic drag has a big effect on fuel mileage at speeds above 45 mph (75 km/h). Reduce your speed and you reduce the drag. Trailers, car top carriers, roof racks and bike racks are also big contributors to increased drag. Always drive in the highest gear possible If your vehicle has a manual transmission, you can boost your fuel economy by up shifting as early as possible. Avoid excessive idling Idling results in 0 miles per gallon. Fuel Economy Minimize the use of the air conditioning system The A/C puts an extra load on the engine which makes it use more fuel. Use the fresh-air ventilation when possible. Plan and combine trips Combine several short trips into one. A warmed-up engine is more fuel efficient than a cold one. Calculating Fuel Economy Measuring Techniques Direct calculation is the recommended source of information about your actual fuel economy. Using frequency of fill-ups or taking fuel gauge readings are NOT accurate measures of fuel economy. Fuel economy may improve over the first several thousand miles. Checking Your Fuel Economy Miles driven 100 Gallons of fuel Liter Miles per Gallon Kilometers L per 100 km 1) Fill the fuel tank until the nozzle automatically clicks off. 2) Reset trip counter to zero. 3) Record the total gallons (liters) needed to refill. 4) Follow one of the simple calculations above. Before Driving 261 Accessories and Modifications Modifying your vehicle, or installing some non-Honda accessories, can make it unsafe. Before you make any modifications or add any accessories, be sure to read the following information. Accessories Your dealer has Honda accessories that allow you to personalize your vehicle. These accessories have been designed and approved for your vehicle, and are covered by warranty. Although non-Honda accessories may fit on your vehicle, they may not meet factory specifications, and could adversely affect your vehicle's handling and stability. Improper accessories or modifications can affect your vehicle's handling, stability, and performance, and cause a crash in which you can be hurt or killed. Follow all instructions in this owner's manual regarding accessories and modifications. When properly installed, cellular phones, alarms, two-way radios, and low-powered audio systems should not interfere with your vehicle's computer controlled systems, such as your airbags, anti-lock brakes, and tire pressure monitoring system (if equipped). Before installing any accessory: Make sure the accessory does not obscure any lights, or interfere with proper vehicle operation or performance. Be sure electronic accessories do not overload electrical circuits (see page 339 ) or interfere with the proper operation of your vehicle. Before installing any electronic accessory, have the installer contact your dealer for assistance. If possible, have your dealer inspect the final installation. Do not install accessories on the side pillars or across the rear windows. Accessories installed in these areas may interfere with proper operation of the side curtain airbags. 262 Accessories and Modifications Modifying Your Vehicle Removing parts from your vehicle, or replacing components with non-Honda components could seriously affect your vehicle's handling, stability, and reliability. Some examples are: Lowering your vehicle with a non-Honda suspension kit that significantly reduces ground clearance can allow the undercarriage to hit speed bumps or other raised objects, which could cause the airbags to deploy. Raising your vehicle with a non-Honda suspension kit can affect the handling and stability. Non-Honda wheels, because they are a universal design, can cause excessive stress on suspension components and will not be compatible with the tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS). Larger or smaller wheels and tires can interfere with the operation of your vehicle's anti-lock brakes and other systems. Modifying your steering wheel or any other part of your vehicle's safety features can make the systems ineffective. If you plan to modify your vehicle, consult your dealer. : If equipped Before Driving 263 Carrying Cargo TRUNK DOOR POCKETS CENTER POCKET Your vehicle has several convenient storage areas: Glove box Door pockets Center pocket Console compartment Trunk However, carrying too much cargo, or improperly storing it, can affect your vehicle's handling, stability, stopping distance, tires, and make it unsafe. Before carrying any type of cargo, be sure to read the following pages. 264 CONSOLE COMPARTMENT GLOVE BOX Before Driving Carrying Cargo Load Limits The maximum load for your vehicle is 850 lbs (385 kg) for U.S. vehicles, and 395 kg for Canadian vehicles. See Tire And Loading Information label attached to the driver's doorjamb. Label Example This figure includes the total weight of all occupants, cargo, and accessories, and the tongue load if you are towing a trailer. Overloading or improper loading can affect handling and stability and cause a crash in which you can be hurt or killed. Follow all load limits and other loading guidelines in this manual. (4)The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and luggage load capacity. For example, if the ``XXX'' amount equals 1,400 lbs. and there will be five 150 lb. passengers in your vehicle, the amount of available cargo and luggage load capacity is 650 lbs. (1,400 750 (5 150) = 650 lbs.) Steps for Determining Correct Load Limit (1)Locate the statement ``The combined weight of occupants and cargo should never exceed XXX kg or XXX lbs.'' on your vehicle's placard. (2)Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers that will be riding in your vehicle. (3)Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers from XXX kg or XXX lbs. (5)Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being loaded on the vehicle. That weight may not safely exceed the available cargo and luggage load capacity calculated in Step 4. (6)If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load from your trailer will be transferred to your vehicle. Consult this manual to determine how this reduces the available cargo and luggage load capacity of your vehicle. CONTINUED 265 Carrying Cargo Example 1 Max Load (850 lbs) Passenger Weight Cargo Weight (150 lbs x 2 = 300 lbs) (550 lbs) Example 2 Max Load (850 lbs) Passenger Weight Cargo Weight (150 lbs x 4 = 600 lbs) (250 lbs) In addition, the total weight of the vehicle, all occupants, accessories, cargo, and trailer tongue load must not exceed the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) or the Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR). Both are on a label on the driver's doorjamb. Example 3 Max Load (850 lbs) Passenger Weight Cargo Weight (150 lbs x 5 = 750 lbs) (100 lbs) 266 Before Driving Carrying Cargo Carrying Items in the Passenger Compartment Store or secure all items that could be thrown around and hurt someone during a crash. Carrying Cargo in the Trunk Distribute cargo evenly on the floor of the trunk, placing the heaviest items on the bottom and as far forward as possible. Air Intake AIR INTAKE Do not put any items on the rear shelf that could cover the IMA battery air intake. They can block your view, or be thrown around the vehicle during a crash. Be sure items placed on the floor behind the front seats cannot roll underneath and interfere with the proper operation of the seats, the sensors under the seats, or the driver's ability to operate the pedals. Keep the glove box closed while driving. If it is open, a passenger could injure their knees during a crash or sudden stop. If you carry large items that prevent you from closing the trunk lid, exhaust gas can enter the passenger area. To avoid the possibility of carbon monoxide poisoning, follow the instructions on page 52 . The air intake for the IMA battery and electronics is located on top of the rear shelf. Do not block this air intake; it may cause the IMA battery and the power control unit to overheat, causing the IMA system to shut down. It will start working again after it cools. CONTINUED 267 Carrying Cargo Do not spill any liquids over the air intake or put any small foreign objects in it. This may damage the IMA battery and the power control unit. 268 Driving This section gives you tips on starting the engine under various conditions, and how to operate the automatic transmissions (CVT). It also includes important information on parking your vehicle, the braking system, the vehicle stability assist (VSA ) system, and the tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS). Preparing to Drive ......................... 270 Starting the Engine........................ 271 Automatic Transmission (CVT) .. 272 Parking............................................ 278 Braking System.............................. 279 Anti-lock Brakes (ABS) ................ 280 Towing a Trailer ............................ 281 Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) ....................................... 282 Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA ), aka Electronic Stability Control (ESC), System ......... 285 Driving 269 Preparing to Drive You should do the following checks and adjustments before you drive your vehicle. 4. Check that any items you may be carrying are stored properly or fastened down securely. 9. Fasten your seat belt. Check that your passengers have fastened their seat belts (see page 14 ). 1. Make sure all windows, mirrors, and outside lights are clean and unobstructed. Remove frost, snow, or ice. 2. Check that the hood and trunk are fully closed. 3. Visually check the tires. If a tire looks low, use a gauge to check its pressure (see page 315 ). 5. Check the seat adjustment (see page 91 ). 6. Check the adjustment of the inside and outside mirrors (see page 98 ). 7. Check the steering wheel adjustment (see page 77 ). 8. Make sure the doors are securely closed and locked. 10. When you start the engine, check the gauges and indicators in the instrument panel (see page 57 ). 270 Starting the Engine 1. Apply the parking brake. 2. In cold weather, turn off all electrical accessories to reduce the drain on the battery. 3. Make sure the shift lever is in Park. Press on the brake pedal. 4. Without touching the accelerator pedal, turn the ignition key to the START (III) position. Do not hold the key in the START (III) position for more than 15 seconds at a time. If the engine does not start right away, pause for at least 10 seconds before trying again. The immobilizer system protects your vehicle f rom thef t. If an improperly coded key (or other device) is used, the engine's f uel system is disabled. For more inf ormation, see page 79 . 5. If the engine does not start within 15 seconds, or starts but stalls right away, repeat step 4 with the accelerator pedal pressed halfway down. If the engine starts, release pressure on the accelerator pedal so the engine does not race. 6. If the engine fails to start, press the accelerator pedal all the way down, and hold it there while starting to clear flooding. If the engine still does not start, return to step 5. Starting in Cold Weather In cold weather, the conventional starter is used instead of the IMA system starter. This is normal. The engine is harder to start in cold weather. Also, the thinner air f ound at altitudes above 8,000 f eet (2,400 meters) adds to this problem. Driving 271 Automatic Transmission (CVT) Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) Honda's Continuously Variable Transmission's unique design provides a smooth, constant flow of power. It is electronically controlled for more precise operation and better fuel economy. Shift Lever Position Indicators These indicators on the instrument panel show which position the shift lever is in. The ``D'' indicator comes on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. If it flashes while driving (in any shift position), it indicates a possible problem in the transmission. If the malfunction indicator lamp comes on along with the ``D'' indicator, there is a problem with the automatic transmission control system. Avoid rapid acceleration, and have the transmission checked by your dealer as soon as possible. 272 Automatic Transmission (CVT) Shif ting RELEASE BUTTON SHIFT LEVER To shift from Park to any position, press firmly on the brake pedal and press the release button on the front of the shift lever, then pull the lever. You cannot shift out of Park when the ignition switch is in the LOCK (0) or the ACCESSORY (I) position. To shift from: P to R R to P N to R S to L L to S S to D D to N D to S N to D R to N Do this: Press the brake pedal and press the release button. Press the release button. Move the lever. Park (P) This position mechanically locks the transmission. Use Park whenever you are turning off or starting the engine. To shift out of Park, you must press on the brake pedal and have your foot off the accelerator pedal. Press the release button on the front of the shift lever to move it. If you have done all of the above and still cannot move the lever out of Park, see Shift Lock Release on page 275 . You must also press the release button to shift into Park. To avoid transmission damage, come to a complete stop before shifting into Park. The shift lever must be in Park before you can remove the key from the ignition switch. Driving CONTINUED 273 Automatic Transmission (CVT) Reverse (R) Press the brake pedal and press the release button on the front of the shift lever to shift from Park to reverse. To shift from reverse to neutral, come to a complete stop, and then shift. Press the release button before shifting into reverse from neutral. Neutral (N) Use neutral if you need to restart a stalled engine, or if it is necessary to stop briefly with the engine idling. Shift to the Park position if you need to leave your vehicle for any reason. Press on the brake pedal when you are moving the shift lever from neutral to another gear. Drive (D) Use this position for your normal driving. The transmission automatically adjusts to keep the engine at the best speed for driving conditions. To help the engine warm up faster, the transmission will select ratios that allow the engine to run at higher speeds when it is cold. Second (S) Selecting Second shifts the transmission into a lower range of ratios for better acceleration and increased engine braking. Use Second when you are going down a steep hill. Low (L) To shift to Low, press the release button on the front of the shift lever. Use Low to get more power when climbing, and for maximum engine braking when going down steep hills. In L, the IMA charge and discharge characteristics will be different than when the vehicle is in D or S. In L, the battery is charged at a higher rate both while driving and when the engine is idling at a stop. The engine will idle at higher speeds when the IMA battery state of charge is low and decrease as the battery reaches a full state of charge. For faster acceleration when in D, S or L, the transmission will automatically ``kick down'' to a lower range of ratios by pushing the accelerator pedal to the floor. Engine Speed Limiter When the vehicle reaches the maximum speed in any shift position, you may feel the engine cut in and out. This is caused by a limiter (112 mph, 180 km/h) in the engine's computer controls. The engine will run normally when you reduce the speed to below the maximum. 274 Driving Automatic Transmission (CVT) Shift Lock Release Do this if pushing on the brake pedal and pressing the release button does not let you shift the transmission out of Park: 1. Set the parking brake. 2. Remove the key from the ignition switch. 3. Put a cloth on the notch of the shift lock release slot cover. Using a small flat-tipped screwdriver or a metal fingernail file, carefully pry on the notch of the cover to remove it. NOTCH COVER 4. Insert the key in the shift lock release slot. 5. Push down on the key while you press the release button on the shift lever and move the shift lever out of Park to neutral. RELEASE BUTTON SHIFT LOCK RELEASE SLOT 6. Remove the key from the shift lock release slot, then install the cover. Make sure the notch on the cover is on the shift lever side. Return the key to the ignition switch, press the brake pedal, and restart the engine. If you need to use the shift lock release, it means your vehicle is developing a problem. Have it checked by your dealer. 275 Automatic Transmission (CVT) Auto Idle Stop To help maximize fuel economy, your Civic Hybrid has an Auto Idle Stop function. Depending on environmental conditions and vehicle operation, the engine will shut off when you come to a stop. According to driving conditions The engine coolant is nearly up to normal operating temperature. According to vehicle controls The shift lever is in D or N. You are not pressing on the accelerator pedal. You are pressing on the brake pedal. Fan speed lower fan speeds, in either AUTO or manual modes. The IMA battery is charged enough to operate the system. The front window defroster is off. Outside temperature is between 10 100 degrees F. The vehicle is not climbing a hill. The Auto Idle Stop function may activate when you slow down. The engine will start again when you release the brake pedal. It will also restart, even if you are still pressing the brake pedal, under these conditions: You move the shift lever from D or N to R or L. You press the accelerator pedal. You are on an incline, and the vehicle begins rolling. 276 Automatic Transmission (CVT) Auto Idle Stop Indicator AUTO IDLE STOP INDICATOR The indicator blinks as a reminder that the engine has stopped because of the Auto Idle Stop function. You cannot restart the engine with the ignition switch when this indicator is blinking. If you open the driver's door when Auto Stop is active, the indicator will blink and you will hear a continuous beep. The beep will stop when you close the door. With the driver's door open, you will hear a continuous beep even if the Auto Idle Stop function is deactivated and the engine restarts. Always turn the ignition switch to the LOCK (0) position and remove the key if you are getting out of the vehicle. Driving 277 Parking Always use the parking brake when you park your vehicle. Make sure the parking brake is set firmly, or your vehicle may roll if it is parked on an incline. Set the parking brake before you put the transmission in Park. This keeps the vehicle from moving and putting pressure on the parking mechanism in the transmission. Parking Tips Make sure the windows are closed. Turn off the lights. Place any packages, valuables, etc., in the trunk or take them with you. Lock the doors. If the vehicle is facing downhill, turn the front wheels toward the curb. Make sure the parking brake is fully released before driving away. Driving with the parking brake partially set can overheat or damage the rear brakes. Check the indicator on the instrument panel to verify that the security system is set. Never park over dry leaves, tall grass, or other flammable materials. The hot three way catalytic converter could cause these materials to catch on fire. Never install a sunshade between the upper and lower meters on the instrument panel. If you do, you could cause heat damage to the upper meter on a very hot day. If the vehicle is facing uphill, turn the front wheels away from the curb. 278 Braking System Your vehicle is equipped with front disc brakes. The brakes on the rear wheels are drum. A power assist helps reduce the effort needed on the brake pedal. The ABS helps you retain steering control when braking very hard. Resting your foot on the pedal keeps the brakes applied lightly, builds up heat, reduces their effectiveness and reduces brake pad life. In addition, fuel economy can be reduced. It also keeps your brake lights on all the time, confusing drivers behind you. Constant application of the brakes when going down a long hill builds up heat and reduces their effectiveness. Use the engine to assist the brakes by taking your foot off the accelerator and downshifting to a lower gear. Check the brakes after driving through deep water. Apply the brakes moderately to see if they feel normal. If not, apply them gently and frequently until they do. Be extra cautious in your driving. Your vehicle is equipped with an advanced hydraulic booster. The advanced hydraulic booster has some features. Power-Assist This feature enables you to press the brake pedal with less force by the help of hydraulic pressure in the oil pressure pump. Cooperative Control with Regenerative Brake This feature controls the braking pressure appropriately, coordinating with the regenerating brake of the IMA motor. Creep Aid System When you release the brake pedal while the Auto Idle Stop function activates, this feature keeps the braking pressure until the engine starts, and prevents the vehicle from dropping back. Brake-Assist This feature helps you apply the brakes with less force during an emergency braking situation. Driving 279 Anti-lock Brakes (ABS) Braking System Design The hydraulic system that operates the brakes has two separate circuits. Each circuit works diagonally across the vehicle (the left-front brake is connected with the right-rear brake, etc.). If one circuit should develop a problem, you will still have braking at two wheels. Brake Pad Wear Indicators If the brake pads need replacing, you will hear a distinctive, metallic screeching sound when you apply the brake pedal. If you do not have the brake pads replaced, they will screech all the time. It is normal for the brakes to occasionally squeal or squeak when you apply them. The anti-lock brake system (ABS) helps prevent the wheels from locking up, and helps you retain steering control by pumping the brakes rapidly, much faster than a person can do it. The electronic brake distribution (EBD) system, which is part of the ABS, also balances the front-to-rear braking distribution according to vehicle loading. You should never pump the brake pedal. Let the ABS work for you by always keeping firm, steady pressure on the brake pedal. This is sometimes referred to as ``stomp and steer.'' You will feel a pulsation in the brake pedal when the ABS activates, and you may hear some noise. This is normal: it is the ABS rapidly pumping the brakes. On dry pavement, you will need to press on the brake pedal very hard before the ABS activates. However, you may feel the ABS activate immediately if you are trying to stop on snow or ice. ABS Indicator If this indicator comes on, the antilock function of the braking system has shut down. The brakes still work like a conventional system, but without anti-lock. You should have your dealer inspect your vehicle as soon as possible. If the ABS indicator comes on while driving, test the brakes as shown on page 338 . 280 Driving Anti-Lock Brakes (ABS), Towing a Trailer If the ABS indicator and the brake system indicator come on together, and the parking brake is fully released, the EBD system may also be shut down. Test your brakes as instructed on page 338 . If the brakes feel normal, drive slowly and have your vehicle repaired by your dealer as soon as possible. Avoid sudden hard braking which could cause the rear wheels to lock up and possibly lead to a loss of control. The VSA indicator will come on along with the ABS indicator. Important Safety Reminders ABS does not reduce the time or distance it takes to stop the vehicle. It only helps with steering control during braking. ABS will not prevent a skid that results from changing direction abruptly, such as trying to take a corner too fast or making a sudden lane change. Always drive at a safe speed for the road and weather conditions. ABS cannot prevent a loss of stability. Always steer moderately when you are braking hard. Severe or sharp steering wheel movement can still cause your vehicle to veer into oncoming traffic or off the road. A vehicle with ABS may require a longer distance to stop on loose or uneven surfaces, such as gravel or snow, than a vehicle without antilock. Towing a Trailer Your vehicle is not designed to tow a trailer. Attempting to do so can void your warranties. 281 Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) U.S. models only Your vehicle is equipped with a tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) that turns on every time you start the engine and monitors the pressure in your tires while driving. Each tire has its own pressure sensor (not including the spare tire). If the air pressure of a tire becomes significantly low while driving, the sensor in that tire immediately sends a signal that causes the low tire pressure indicator to come on. Low Tire Pressure Indicator When the low tire pressure indicator is on, one or more of your tires is significantly underinflated. You should stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate them to the proper pressure as indicated on the vehicle's tire information placard. If you think you can safely drive a short distance to a service station, proceed slowly, and inflate the tire to the recommended pressure shown on the driver's doorjamb. Driving on a significantly under inflated tire causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. Underinflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle's handling and stopping ability. Because tire pressure varies by temperature and other conditions, the low tire pressure indicator may come on unexpectedly. If the tire is flat, or if the tire pressure is too low to continue driving, replace the tire with the compact spare tire (see page 324 ). If you cannot make the low tire pressure indicator go out after inflating the tires to the specified values, have your dealer check the system as soon as possible. 282 Driving Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) For example, if you check and fill your tires in a warm area, then drive in extremely cold weather, the tire pressure will be lower than measured and could be underinflated and cause the low tire pressure indicator to come on. Or, if you check and adjust your tire pressure in cooler conditions, and drive into extremely hot conditions, the tire may become overinflated. However, the low tire pressure indicator will not come on if the tires are overinflated. information label and in the owner's manual (see page 316 ). Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Indicator This indicator comes on and stays on if there is a problem with the tire pressure monitoring system. If this happens, the system will shut off and no longer monitor tire pressures. Have the system checked by your dealer as soon as possible. If the low tire pressure indicator or TPMS indicator comes on, the VSA system automatically turns on even if the VSA system is turned off by pressing the VSA OFF switch (see page 286 ). If this happens, you cannot turn the VSA system off by pressing the VSA OFF switch again. When you restart the vehicle with the compact spare tire, the TPMS indicator may also come on and stay on after driving several miles (kilometers). Refer to page 315 for tire inflation guidelines. Although your tire pressure is monitored, you must manually check the tire pressures monthly. Each tire, including the spare, should be checked monthly when cold, and set to the recommended inflation pressure as specified on the tire 283 Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Changing a Tire with TPMS If you have a flat tire, the low tire pressure indicator will come on. Replace the flat tire with the compact spare tire (see page 324 ). Each wheel (except the compact spare tire wheel) is equipped with a tire pressure sensor mounted inside the tire behind the valve stem. You must use TPMS specific wheels. It is recommended that you always have your tires serviced by your dealer or qualified technician. After you replace the flat tire with the compact spare tire, the low tire pressure indicator stays on. This is normal; the system is not monitoring the spare tire pressure. Manually check the spare tire pressure to be sure it is correct. After several miles (kilometers) driving with the compact spare tire, the TPMS indicator comes on and the low tire pressure indicator goes off. The low tire pressure indicator or the TPMS indicator will go off, after several miles (kilometers) driving, when you replace the spare tire with the specified regular tire equipped with the tire pressure monitor sensor. Never use a puncture-repairing agent in a flat tire. If used, you will have to replace the tire pressure sensor. Have the flat tire repaired by your dealer as soon as possible. As required by the FCC: This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user's authority to operate the equipment. This device complies with Industry Canada Standard RSS-210. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference that may cause undesired operation of the device. 284 Driving Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA ), aka Electronic Stability Control (ESC), System If equipped The vehicle stability assist (VSA) system helps to stabilize the vehicle during cornering if the vehicle turns more or less than desired. It also assists you in maintaining traction while accelerating on loose or slippery road surfaces. It does this by regulating the engine's output and by selectively applying the brakes. When VSA activates, you may notice that the engine does not respond to the accelerator in the same way it does at other times. There may also be some noise from the VSA hydraulic system. You will also see the VSA activation indicator blink. The VSA system cannot enhance the vehicle's driving stability in all situations and does not control your vehicle's entire braking system. It is still your responsibility to drive and corner at reasonable speeds and to leave a sufficient margin of safety. VSA Activation Indicator When VSA activates, you will see the VSA Activation indicator blink. Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System Indicator If this indicator comes on while driving, pull to the side of the road when it is safe, and turn off the engine. Reset the system by restarting the engine. If the VSA system indicator stays on or comes back on while driving, have the VSA system inspected by your dealer. If the indicator does not come on when the ignition switch is turned to the ON (II) position, there may be a problem with the VSA system. Have your dealer inspect your vehicle as soon as possible. NOTE: The main function of the VSA system is generally known as Electronic Stability Control (ESC). The system also includes a traction control function. On U.S. models If the low tire pressure indicator or TPMS indicator comes on, the VSA system automatically turns on even if the VSA system is turned off by pressing the VSA OFF switch (see page 279 ). If this happens, you cannot turn the VSA system off by pressing the VSA OFF switch again. Without VSA, your vehicle will have normal braking and cornering ability, but it will not have VSA traction and stability enhancement. 285 Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA ), aka Electronic Stability Control (ESC), System VSA OFF Switch VSA OFF SWITCH This switch is under the driver's side vent. To turn the VSA system on and off, press and hold it until you hear a beep. When VSA is off, the VSA activation indicator comes on as a reminder. Press and hold the switch again. It turns the system back on. VSA is turned on every time you start the engine, even if you turned it off the last time you drove the vehicle. In certain unusual conditions when your vehicle gets stuck in shallow mud or fresh snow, it may be easier to free it with the VSA temporarily switched off. When the VSA system is off, the traction control system is also off. You should only attempt to free your vehicle with the VSA off if you are not able to free it when the VSA is on. VSA and Tire Sizes Driving with varying tire or wheel sizes may cause the VSA to malfunction. When replacing tires, make sure they are of the same size and type as your original tires (see page 319 ). If you install winter tires, make sure they are the same size as those that were originally supplied with your vehicle. Exercise the same caution during winter driving as you would if your vehicle was not equipped with VSA. Immediately after freeing your vehicle, be sure to switch the VSA on again. We do not recommend driving your vehicle with the VSA and traction control systems switched off. 286 Maintenance This section explains why it is important to keep your vehicle well maintained and how to follow basic maintenance safety precautions. This section also includes instructions on how to read the maintenance minder messages on the information display, and instructions for simple maintenance tasks you may want to take care of yourself. If you have the skills and tools to perform more complex maintenance tasks on your vehicle, you may want to purchase the service manual. See page 283 for information on how to obtain a copy, or see your dealer. Maintenance Safety....................... 288 Maintenance Minder..................... 289 Fluid Locations............................... 296 Adding Engine Oil ......................... 297 Changing the Oil and Filter.......... 298 Engine Coolant............................... 300 Windshield Washers ..................... 302 Transmission Fluid.........................303 Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) ............. 303 Brake Fluid..................................... 304 Lights .............................................. 305 Roof Antenna ................................. 310 Cleaning the Seat Belts................. 311 Floor Mats ...................................... 311 Dust and Pollen Filter ................... 312 Wiper Blades .................................. 312 Wheels ............................................ 315 Tires ................................................ 315 Checking the 12 Volt Battery....... 321 Vehicle Storage.............................. 322 Maintenance 287 Maintenance Safety All service items not detailed in this section should be performed by a certified technician or qualified mechanic. Important Safety Precautions To eliminate potential hazards, read the instructions before you begin, and make sure you have the tools and skills required. Make sure your vehicle is parked on level ground, the parking brake is set, and the engine is off. To clean parts, use a commercially available degreaser or parts cleaner, not gasoline. To reduce the possibility of fire or explosion, keep cigarettes, sparks, and flames away from the battery and all fuel-related parts. Wear eye protection and protective clothing when working with the battery or compressed air. Burns from hot parts. Let the engine and exhaust system cool down before touching any parts. Improperly maintaining this vehicle, or failing to correct a problem before driving can cause a crash in which you can be seriously hurt or killed. Always follow the inspection and maintenance recommendations and schedules in this owner's manual. Injury from moving parts. Do not run the engine unless instructed to do so. Failure to properly follow maintenance instructions and precautions can cause you to be seriously hurt or killed. Always follow the procedures and precautions in this owner's manual. Potential Vehicle Hazards Carbon Monoxide poison from engine exhaust. Be sure there is adequate ventilation whenever you operate the engine. Some of the most important safety precautions are given here. However, we cannot warn you of every conceivable hazard that can arise in performing maintenance. Only you can decide whether or not you should perform a given task. 288 Maintenance Minder Your vehicle displays engine oil life and maintenance service items on the information display to show you when you should have your dealer perform engine oil replacement and indicated maintenance service. Engine Oil Life Display SEL/RESET BUTTON Based on the engine operating conditions and accumulated engine revolutions, the onboard computer in your vehicle calculates the remaining engine oil life and displays it as a percentage. ENGINE OIL LIFE DISPLAY To see the current engine oil life, turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position, and press the SEL/ RESET button repeatedly until the engine oil life display appears (see page 65 ). The remaining engine oil life is shown on the display according to this table: Calculated Engine Oil Life (%) 100 %91 % 90 %81 % 80 %71 % 70 %61 % 60 %51 % 50 %41 % 40 %31 % 30 %21 % 20 %16 % 15 %11 % 10 %6 % 5 %1 % 0% Displayed Engine Oil Life (%) 100 % 90 % 80 % 70 % 60 % 50 % 40 % 30 % 20 % 15 % 10 % 5% 0% Maintenance CONTINUED 289 Maintenance Minder MAINTENANCE ITEM CODE(S) The maintenance item code or codes indicate the main and sub items required at the time of the oil change (see page 295 ). ENGINE OIL MAINTENANCE LIFE DISPLAY MINDER INDICATOR If the remaining engine oil life is 15 to 6 percent, you will see the engine oil life indicator every time you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. The maintenance minder indicator will also come on, and the maintenance item code(s) for other scheduled maintenance items needing service will be displayed next to the engine oil life indicator. 290 When the remaining engine oil life is 5 to 1 percent, you will see a ``SERVICE OIL LIFE'' message along with the same maintenance item code(s), every time you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. Maintenance Minder When the remaining engine oil life is 0 percent, the engine oil life indicator will blink. The display comes on every time you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. When you see this message, have the indicated maintenance performed by your dealer as soon as possible. If you still do not perform the indicated maintenance, you will see negative mileage. It is displayed when you drive more than 10 miles (for U.S. models) or 10 km (for Canadian models) after seeing the 0 percent message. Afterward, it shows your driving distance if you continue to drive. Immediately have the indicated maintenance done by your dealer. You can change the information display from the engine oil life display to the odometer, the trip meter, or the outside temperature every time you press and release the SEL/RESET button. When the engine oil life is 0 percent or negative mileage, the maintenance minder indicator remains on even if you change the information display. Immediately have the service done, and make sure to reset the display as described on the next page. 291 Maintenance Maintenance Minder Maintenance Main Items and Sub Items MAINTENANCE MAIN ITEM MAINTENANCE SUB ITEM All maintenance items displayed on the information display are in code. For an explanation of these maintenance codes, see page 295 . Resetting the Engine Oil Life Display Your dealer will reset the display after completing the required maintenance service. You will see ``OIL LIFE 100%'' on the information display the next time you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. If maintenance service is done by someone other than your dealer, reset the maintenance minder as follows: 1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. 2. Press the SEL/RESET button repeatedly until the engine oil life is displayed. 3. Press the SEL/RESET button for about 10 seconds. The engine oil life and the maintenance item code(s) will blink. 292 Maintenance Minder 4. Press the SEL/RESET button for more than 5 seconds. The maintenance item code(s) will disappear, and the engine oil life will reset to ``100.'' Important Maintenance Precautions If you have the required service done but do not reset the display, or reset the display without doing the service, the system will not show the proper maintenance intervals. This can lead to serious mechanical problems because you will no longer have an accurate record of when maintenance is needed. Your authorized Honda dealer knows your vehicle best and can provide competent, efficient service. However, service at a dealer is not mandatory to keep your warranties in effect. Maintenance may be done by any qualified service facility or person who is skilled in this type of automotive service. Make sure to have the service facility or person reset the display as previously described. Keep all receipts as proof of completion, and have the person who does the work fill out your Honda Service History or Canadian Maintenance Log. Check your warranty booklet for more information. We recommend using Honda parts and fluids whenever you have maintenance done. These are manufactured to the same high quality standards as the original components, so you can be confident of their performance and durability. CONTINUED 293 Maintenance Maintenance Minder U.S. Vehicles: Maintenance, replacement, or repair of emissions control devices and systems may be done by any automotive repair establishment or individual using parts that are ``certified'' to EPA standards. According to state and federal regulations, failure to perform maintenance on the items marked with will not void your emissions warranties. However, all maintenance services should be performed in accordance with the intervals indicated by the information display. Owner's Maintenance Checks You should check the following items at the specified intervals. If you are unsure of how to perform any check, turn to the appropriate page listed. Engine oil level Check every time you fill the fuel tank. See page 257 . Engine coolant level Check the radiator reserve tank every time you fill the fuel tank. See page 258 . Automatic transmission Check the fluid level monthly. See page 303 . Brakes Check the fluid level monthly. See page 304 . Tires Check the tire pressure monthly. Examine the tread for wear and foreign objects. See page 315 . 294 Lights Check the operation of the headlights, parking lights, taillights, high-mount brake light, turn signals, brake lights, and license plate light monthly. See page 305 . Maintenance Minder Symbol A B Maintenance Main Items Replace engine oil Replace engine oil and oil filter Inspect front and rear brakes Check parking brake adjustment Inspect these items: Tie rod ends, steering gear box, and boots Suspension components Driveshaft boots Brake hoses and lines (including ABS) All fluid levels and condition of fluids Exhaust system Fuel lines and connections : If the message ``SERVICE OIL'' does not appear more than 12 months after the display is reset, change the engine oil every year. : See information on maintenance and emissions warranty on page 294 . NOTE: Independent of the maintenance minder display, replace the brake fluid every 3 years. Inspect idle speed every 160,000 miles (256,000 km). Adjust the valves during services A, B, 1, 2, or 3 only if they are noisy. Symbol 1 2 3 4 5 Maintenance Sub Items Rotate tires Replace air cleaner element If you drive in dusty conditions, replace every 15,000 miles (24,000 km). Replace dust and pollen filter If you drive primarily in urban areas that have high concentrations of soot in the air from industry and from diesel-powered vehicles, replace every 15,000 miles (24,000 km). Inspect drive belt Replace transmission fluid Replace spark plugs Inspect valve clearance Replace engine coolant Maintenance Minder 295 Fluid Locations ENGINE OIL DIPSTICK (Orange loop) ENGINE OIL FILL CAP WASHER FLUID (Blue cap) 296 BRAKE FLUID (Black cap) AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION (CVT) FLUID DIPSTICK (Yellow loop) ENGINE COOLANT RESERVOIR RADIATOR CAP Adding Engine Oil ENGINE OIL FILL CAP Recommended Engine Oil Oil is a major contributor to your engine's performance and longevity. Always use a premium-grade 0W-20 detergent oil displaying the API Certification Seal. This seal indicates the oil is energy conserving, and that it meets the American Petroleum Institute's latest requirements. API CERTIFICATION SEAL optimum engine protection. Make sure the API Certification Seal says ``For Gasoline Engines''. The oil viscosity or weight is provided on the container's label. Unscrew and remove the engine oil fill cap on the valve cover. Pour the oil slowly and carefully so you do not spill any. Clean up any spills immediately. Spilled oil could damage components in the engine compartment. Reinstall the engine oil fill cap, and tighten it securely. Wait a few minutes, and recheck the oil level on the engine oil dipstick. Do not fill above the upper mark; you could damage the engine. Honda Motor Oil is the preferred 0W-20 lubricant for your vehicle. It is highly recommended that you use Honda Motor Oil in your vehicle for Ambient Temperature A very low-viscosity, fuel-efficient 0W-20 oil is the preferred engine lubricant for your Civic Hybrid. This special oil is formulated to help your engine use less fuel. It is available at your dealer. A 5W-20 oil may be used if 0W-20 is not available. 297 Maintenance Adding Engine Oil, Changing the Oil and Filter Synthetic Oil You may use a synthetic motor oil if it meets the same requirements given for a conventional motor oil: it displays the API certification seal, and it is the proper weight. You must follow the oil and filter change intervals shown on the information display. Engine Oil Additives Your vehicle does not require any oil additives. Additives may adversely affect the engine or transmission performance and durability. Changing the Oil and Filter Always change the oil and filter according to the maintenance messages shown on the information display. The oil and filter collect contaminants that can damage your engine if they are not removed regularly. Changing the oil and filter requires special tools and access from underneath the vehicle. The vehicle should be raised on a service stationtype hydraulic lift for this service. Unless you have the knowledge and proper equipment, you should have this maintenance done by a skilled mechanic. 1. Run the engine until it reaches normal operating temperature, then shut it off. 2. Open the hood, and remove the engine oil fill cap. HOLDING CLIP BOLTS 3. Only on U.S. models Remove the nine holding clips with a flat-tipped screwdriver and two bolts, then pull the undercover down. 298 DRAIN BOLT WASHER 4. Remove the oil drain bolt and washer from the bottom of the engine. Drain the oil into an appropriate container. Changing the Oil and Filter OIL FILTER 7. Put a new washer on the drain bolt, then reinstall the drain bolt. Tighten the drain bolt to: 29 lbf·ft (39 N·m , 4.0 kgf·m) 8. Refill the engine with the recommended oil. Engine oil change capacity (including filter): 5. Remove the oil filter, and let the remaining oil drain. A special wrench (available from your dealer) is required. Make sure the oil filter gasket is not stuck to the engine block. If it is, remove it before installing a new oil filter. 6. Install a new oil filter according to the instructions that come with it. 3.4 US qt (3.2 ) 9. Reinstall the engine oil fill cap. Start the engine. The oil pressure indicator should go out within 5 seconds. If it does not, turn off the engine, and check your work. 10. Let the engine run for several minutes, then check the drain bolt and oil filter for leaks. CONTINUED 299 Maintenance Changing the Oil and Filter, Engine Coolant 11. Turn off the engine, let it sit for several minutes, then check the oil level on the dipstick. If necessary, add more oil. Adding Engine Coolant RESERVE TANK 12. Only on U.S. models Put the under-cover back in place and reinstall the nine holding clips. Lock the clips securely by pushing on the center of each clip. Improper disposal of engine oil can be harmf ul to the environment. If you change your own oil, please dispose of the used oil properly. Put it in a sealed container and take it to a recycling center. Do not discard it in a trash bin or dump it on the ground. If the coolant level in the reserve tank is at or below the MIN line, add coolant to bring it up to between the MIN and MAX lines. Inspect the cooling system for leaks. Always use Honda Long-life Antifreeze/Coolant Type 2. This coolant is pre-mixed with 50 percent antifreeze and 50 percent distilled water. Never add straight antifreeze or plain water. If Honda antifreeze/coolant is not available, you may use another major-brand non-silicate coolant as a temporary replacement. Make sure it is a high-quality coolant recommended for aluminum engines. Continued use of any non-Honda coolant can result in corrosion, causing the cooling system to malfunction or fail. Have the cooling system flushed and refilled with Honda antifreeze/coolant as soon as possible. 300 Engine Coolant If the reserve tank is completely empty, you should also check the coolant level in the radiator. Removing the radiator cap while the engine is hot can cause the coolant to spray out, seriously scalding you. Always let the engine and radiator cool down before removing the radiator cap. 4. The coolant level should be up to the base of the filler neck. Add coolant if it is low. Pour the coolant slowly and carefully so you do not spill any. Clean up any spill immediately; it could damage components in the engine compartment. RADIATOR CAP 1. Make sure the engine and radiator are cool. 2. Relieve any pressure in the cooling system by turning the radiator cap counterclockwise, without pressing down. 3. Remove the radiator cap by pushing down and turning counterclockwise. 5. Put the radiator cap back on, and tighten it fully. 6. Pour coolant into the reserve tank. Fill it to halfway between the MAX and MIN marks. Put the cap back on the reserve tank. Do not add any rust inhibitors or other additives to your vehicle's cooling system. They may not be compatible with the coolant or engine components. Maintenance 301 Windshield Washers Check the fluid level in the windshield washer reservoir at least monthly during normal use. On Canadian models: The low washer level indicator comes on when the level is low (see page 61 ). Check the fluid level by removing the cap and looking at the level gauge. Fill the reservoir with a good-quality windshield washer fluid. This increases the cleaning capability and prevents freezing in cold weather. When you refill the reservoir, clean the edges of the windshield wiper blades with windshield washer fluid on a clean cloth. This will help to condition them. Do not use engine antif reeze or a vinegar/water solution in the windshield washer reservoir. Antif reeze can damage your vehicle's paint, while a vinegar/water solution can damage the windshield washer pump. Use only commercially-available windshield washer f luid. 302 Transmission Fluid Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) 2. Remove the dipstick (yellow loop) from the transmission, and wipe it with a clean cloth. 3. Insert the dipstick all the way into the transmission securely as shown in the illustration. DIPSTICK Check the fluid level with the engine at normal operating temperature. 1. Park the vehicle on level ground. Start the engine, let it run until the radiator fan comes on, then shut off the engine. For accurate results, wait about 60 seconds (but no longer than 90 seconds) before doing step 2. HOT Range UPPER MARK LOWER MARK 4. Remove the dipstick and check the fluid level. It should be between the upper and lower marks within the HOT range. 5. If the level is below the lower mark, add fluid into the dipstick hole to bring it to the level between the upper and lower marks. Pour the fluid slowly and carefully so you do not spill any. Clean up any spill immediately; it could damage components in the engine compartment. Always use Honda CVT Fluid (Continuously Variable Transmission fluid). CONTINUED 303 Maintenance Transmission Fluid, Brake Fluid 6. Insert the dipstick all the way back into the transmission securely. The transmission should be drained and refilled with new fluid when this service is indicated by a maintenance message on the information display. If you are not sure how to add fluid, contact your dealer. Brake Fluid Check the brake fluid level in the MAX reservoirs monthly. Replace the brake fluid every 3 years, independent of mileage. Always use Honda Heavy Duty Brake Fluid DOT 3. If it is not available, you should use only DOT 3 or DOT 4 fluid, from a sealed container, as a temporary replacement. Using any non-Honda brake fluid can cause corrosion and decrease the life of the system. Have the brake system flushed and refilled with Honda Heavy Duty Brake Fluid DOT 3 as soon as possible. Brake fluid marked DOT 5 is not compatible with your vehicle's braking system and can cause extensive damage. MIN Check the fluid level several seconds after you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. The fluid level should be between the MIN and MAX marks on the side of the reservoir. If the level is at or below the MIN mark, your brake system needs attention. Have the brake system inspected for leaks or worn brake pads. 304 Lights Headlight Aiming The headlights were properly aimed when your vehicle was new. If you regularly carry heavy items in the trunk, readjustment may be required. Adjustments should be done by your dealer or another qualified technician. High Beam Headlight CLIP Replacing a Headlight Bulb Your vehicle has halogen headlight bulbs. When replacing a bulb, handle it by its base, and protect the glass from contact with your skin or hard objects. If you touch the glass, clean it with denatured alcohol and a clean cloth. CLIP COOLANT TUBE 1. Open the hood. To change a bulb on the left side, remove the coolant tube from the two clips. Halogen headlight bulbs get very hot when lit. Oil, perspiration, or a scratch on the glass can cause the bulb to overheat and shatter. HOLDER Remove the reserve tank from its holder by pulling it straight up. CONTINUED 305 Maintenance Lights BULB TAB CONNECTOR 2. Remove the bulb from the headlight assembly by turning it one-quarter turn counterclockwise. 3. Remove the electrical connector from the bulb by pushing on the tab and pulling the connector down. 4. Push the electrical connector back onto the bulb. Make sure it is on all the way. 5. Install the new bulb, and turn it one-quarter turn clockwise to lock it in place. 6. Turn on the headlights to test the new bulb. 7. If you replaced a headlight bulb on the driver's side, reinstall the engine coolant reserve tank. Low Beam Headlight HOLDING CLIP 1. To change the bulb on the driver's side, start the engine, turn the steering wheel all the way to the right, then turn off the engine. To change the bulb on the passenger's side, turn the steering wheel to the left. 2. Use a flat-tipped screwdriver to remove the two holding clips from the inner fender, and pull the inner fender cover back. 306 Lights BULB 5. Install the new bulb, and turn it one-quarter turn clockwise to lock it in place. 6. Push the electrical connector back onto the bulb. Make sure it is on all the way. 7. Turn on the headlights to test the new bulb. TAB 3. Remove the bulb from the headlight assembly by turning it one-quarter turn counterclockwise. 8. Reinstall the inner fender cover. Then reinstall the holding clips, and lock them in place by pushing on their centers. 4. Remove the electrical connector from the bulb by pushing on the tab and pulling the connector down. Replacing the Front Side Marker/ Turn Signal Light Bulb HOLDING CLIP 1. To change the bulb on the driver's side, start the engine, turn the steering wheel all the way to the right, then turn off the engine. To change the bulb on the passenger's side, turn the steering wheel to the left. Maintenance CONTINUED 307 Lights BULB SOCKET 4. Remove the bulb from the socket by pushing the bulb in and turning it counterclockwise until it unlocks. 5. Install the new bulb in the socket. Turn it clockwise to lock it in place. Replacing Rear Bulbs (In Fenders) FASTENER 6. Insert the socket back into the headlight assembly. Turn it clockwise to lock it in place. 7. Turn on the lights to make sure the new bulb is working. 2. Use a flat-tipped screwdriver to remove the two holding clips from the inner fender, and pull the inner fender cover back. 8. Reinstall the inner fender cover. Then reinstall the holding clips, and lock them in place by pushing on their centers. 3. Remove the bulb from the headlight assembly by turning it one-quarter turn counterclockwise. FASTENER 1. Open the trunk. Use the flat-tipped screwdriver to remove the screws in the center of each fastener on the side of the boot lining. Remove the fasteners first, then pull the lining back carefully. 2. Determine which of the four bulbs is burned out: stop/tail-light, backup light, side marker light, or turn signal light. 308 BULBS Lights Replacing Rear Bulbs (in Trunk Lid) BULB SOCKETS Maintenance SOCKETS BULB 3. Remove the socket by turning it 6. Turn on the lights to make sure one-quarter turn counterclockwise. the new bulb is working. 4. Pull the bulb straight out of its socket. Push the new bulb straight into the socket until it bottoms. 7. Reinstall the trunk lining. Make sure it is installed under the edge of the trunk seal. 5. Reinstall the socket into the light assembly by turning it clockwise until it locks. 8. Put the fasteners into the holes on the side of the trunk lining. Reinstall the screws. FASTENER 1. Open the trunk. Use the Phillips-head screwdriver to remove the screws in the center of each fastener on the back of the boot lid. Remove the fasteners first, then pull the lining back carefully. CONTINUED 309 Lights, Roof Antenna BULB 3. Pull the bulb straight out of its socket. Push the new bulb straight into the socket until it bottoms. 4. Insert the socket back into the light assembly. Turn it clockwise to lock it in place. 5. Turn on the lights to make sure the new bulb is working. SOCKET 2. Remove the socket by turning it one-quarter turn counterclockwise. 6. Push the trunk lid trim back into position. 7. Put the fasteners into the holes on the trunk lid trim. Reinstall the screws. Roof Antenna Before using an automatic car wash, remove the radio antenna so it does not get damaged. Remove the antenna by unscrewing it. When you reinstall the antenna, tighten it securely. Before entering or parking in areas with low ceiling height, remove the antenna. 310 Cleaning the Seat Belts LOOP Floor Mats Cleaning the Seat Belts, Floor Mats If you use non-Honda floor mats, make sure they fit properly and that they can be used with the floor mat anchors. Do not put additional floor mats on top of the anchored mats. Maintenance If your seat belts get dirty, use a soft brush with a mixture of mild soap and warm water to clean them. Do not use bleach, dye, or cleaning solvents. Let the belts air dry before you use the vehicle. Dirt build-up in the loops of the seat belt anchors can cause the belts to retract slowly. Wipe the insides of the loops with a clean cloth dampened in mild soap and warm water or isopropyl alcohol. The driver's floor mat that came with your vehicle hooks over the floor mat anchors. This keeps the floor mat from sliding forward and possibly interfering with the pedals or making the front passenger's weight sensors ineffective. If you remove the driver's floor mat, make sure to re-anchor it when you put it back in your vehicle. 311 Dust and Pollen Filter, Wiper Blades Dust and Pollen Filter This filter removes the dust and pollen that is brought in from the outside through the heating and cooling system/climate control system. Have your dealer replace the filter when this service is indicated by a maintenance message on the information display. It should be replaced every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) if you drive primarily in urban areas that have high concentrations of soot in the air, or if the flow from the heating and cooling system becomes less than usual. Wiper Blades Check the condition of the wiper blades at least every 6 months. Replace them if you find signs of cracking in the rubber, and areas that are getting hard or if they leave streaks and unwiped areas when used. WIPER ARMS To replace a wiper blade: 1. Raise each wiper arm off the windshield, lifting the driver's side first, then the passenger's side. Do not open the hood when the wiper arms are raised, or you will damage the hood and wiper arms. 312 WIPER ARM BLADE Wiper Blades Maintenance LOCK TAB 2. Disconnect the blade assembly from the wiper arm: Put a cloth on the edge of the lock tab, then push up on the lock tab carefully with a flat-tip screwdriver. Pivot the blade assembly toward the wiper arm until it releases from the wiper arm. When replacing a wiper blade, make sure not to drop the wiper blade or wiper arm down on the windshield. 3. Remove the blade from its holder by grabbing the tabbed end of the blade. Pull firmly until the tabs come out of the holder. CONTINUED 313 Wiper Blades 4. Examine the new wiper blades. If they have no plastic or metal reinforcement along the back edge, remove the metal TAB reinforcement strips from the old wiper blade, and install them in the slots along the edge of the new blade. REINFORCEMENT TOP BLADE INDENT 6. Slide the wiper blade assembly onto the wiper arm. Make sure it locks in place. 7. Make sure the blade is completely installed and that its edge is not bunched up. 8. Lower the wiper arm down against the windshield, the passenger's side first, then the driver's side. Make sure the three rubber tabs inside the blade fit to each notch of the reinforcement, as shown. 5. Place the top of the wiper blade on the end of the blade assembly, and slide the blade onto the assembly in the direction pointed to by the arrow. Make sure the tab on the blade assembly fits in the indent of the wiper blade and the blade is completely installed. 314 Wheels, Tires Wheels Clean the wheels as you would the rest of the exterior. Wash them with the same solution, and rinse them thoroughly. Tires To safely operate your vehicle, your tires must be the proper type and size, in good condition with adequate tread, and correctly inflated. Aluminum alloy wheels have a protective clear-coat that keeps the aluminum from corroding and tarnishing. Cleaning the wheels with harsh chemicals (including some commercial wheel cleaners) or a stiff brush can damage the clear-coat. To clean the wheels, use a mild detergent and a soft brush or sponge. The following pages give more detailed information on how to take care of your tires and what to do when they need to be replaced. Using tires that are excessively worn or improperly inflated can cause a crash in which you can be seriously hurt or killed. Follow all instructions in this owner's manual regarding tire inflation and maintenance. Inflation Guidelines Keeping the tires properly inflated provides the best combination of handling, tread life, and riding comfort. Underinflated tires wear unevenly, adversely affect handling and fuel economy, and are more likely to fail from being overheated. Overinflated tires can make your vehicle ride more harshly, are more prone to damage from road hazards, and wear unevenly. On U.S. models The tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) warns you when a tire pressure is low. See page 282 for more information. On Canadian models We recommend that you visually check your tires every day. If you think a tire might be low, check it immediately with a tire gauge. CONTINUED 315 Maintenance Tires On U.S. models Even though your vehicle is equipped with TPMS, we recommend that you visually check your tires every day. If you think a tire might be low, check it immediately with a tire gauge. Use a gauge to measure the air pressure in each tire at least once a month. Even tires that are in good condition may lose 1 to 2 psi (10 to 20 kPa, 0.1 to 0.2 kgf/cm ) per month. Remember to check the spare tire at the same time. Check the air pressures when the tires are cold. This means the vehicle has been parked for at least 3 hours, or driven less than 1 mile (1.6 km). Add or release air, if needed, to match the recommended cold tire pressures. If you check air pressures when the tires are hot [driven for several miles (kilometers)], you will see readings 4 to 6 psi (30 to 40 kPa, 0.3 to 0.4 kgf/cm ) higher than the cold readings. This is normal. Do not let air out to match the recommended cold air pressure. The tire will be underinflated. You should get your own tire pressure gauge and use it whenever you check your tire pressures. This will make it easier for you to tell if a pressure loss is due to a tire problem and not due to a variation between gauges. While tubeless tires have some ability to self-seal if they are punctured, you should look closely for punctures if a tire starts losing pressure. Recommended Tire Pressures The following chart shows the recommended cold tire pressures for most normal driving conditions. Tire Size P195/65R15 89S Cold Tire Pressure Front/Rear: 32 psi (220 kPa , 2.2 kgf/cm ) The compact spare tire pressure is: 60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm ) See page 351 or refer to the tire placard on the driver's doorjamb for correct tire pressure. For convenience, the recommended tire sizes and cold tire pressures are on a label on the driver's doorjamb. 316 Tires Tire Inspection Every time you check inflation, you should also examine the tires for damage, foreign objects, and wear. You should look for: Bumps or bulges in the tread or side of the tire. Replace the tire if you find either of these conditions. Cuts, splits, or cracks in the side of the tire. Replace the tire if you can see fabric or cord. Excessive tread wear. INDICATOR LOCATION MARKS TREAD WEAR INDICATOR Your tires have wear indicators molded into the tread. When the tread wears down, you will see a 1/2 inch (12.7 mm) wide band across the tread. This shows there is less than 1/16 inch (1.6 mm) of tread left on the tire. A tire this worn gives very little traction on wet roads. You should replace the tire if you can see three or more tread wear indicators. Tire Service Life The service life of your tires is dependent on many factors, including, but not limited to, driving habits, road conditions, vehicle loading, inflation pressure, maintenance history, speed, and environmental conditions (even when the tires are not in use). In addition to your regular inspections and inflation pressure maintenance, it is recommended that you have annual inspections performed once the tires reach five years old. It is also recommended that all tires, including the spare, be removed from service after 10 years from the date of manufacture, regardless of their condition or state of wear. The last four digits of the TIN (tire identification number) are found on the sidewall of the tire and indicate the date of manufacture (See Tire Labeling on page 353 ). 317 Maintenance Tires Tire Maintenance In addition to proper inflation, correct wheel alignment helps to decrease tire wear. If you find a tire is worn unevenly, have your dealer check the wheel alignment. Have your dealer check the tires if you feel a consistent vibration while driving. A tire should always be rebalanced if it is removed from the wheel. When you have new tires installed, make sure they are balanced. This increases riding comfort and tire life. For best results, have the installer perform a dynamic balance. Improper wheel weights can damage your vehicle's aluminum wheels. Use only Honda wheel weights f or balancing. Tire Rotation Front Front (Front Non-directional (Front Directional Tires and Wheels) Tires and Wheels) To help increase tire life and distribute wear more evenly, rotate the tires according to the maintenance messages displayed on the information display. Move the tires to the positions shown in the chart each time they are rotated. If you purchase directional tires, rotate only front-to-back. Replacing Tires and Wheels Replace your tires with radial tires of the same size, load range, speed rating, and maximum cold tire pressure rating (as shown on the tire's sidewall). Mixing radial and bias-ply tires on your vehicle can reduce braking ability, traction, and steering accuracy. Using tires of a different size or construction can cause the ABS and vehicle stability assist system (VSA) to work inconsistently. It is best to replace all four tires at the same time. If that is not possible or necessary, replace the two front tires or two rear tires as a pair. Replacing just one tire can seriously affect your vehicle's handling. 318 Tires The ABS and VSA system work by comparing the speed of the wheels. When replacing tires, use the same size originally supplied with the vehicle. Tire size and construction can affect wheel speed and may cause the ABS or VSA system to activate. If you ever replace a wheel, make sure that the wheel's specifications match those of the original wheels. Also be sure you use only TPMS specific wheels (if equipped). If you do not, the tire pressure monitoring system will not work. Replacement wheels are available at your dealer. Installing improper tires on your vehicle can affect handling and stability. This can cause a crash in which you can be seriously hurt or killed. Always use the size and type of tires recommended in this owner's manual. Wheel and Tire Specifications Wheels: 15 x 6 J Tires: P195/65R15 89S See page 352 for DOT tire quality grading information, and page 354 for tire size information. Winter Driving Tires marked ``M S'' or ``All Season'' on the sidewall have an allweather tread design suitable for most winter driving conditions. For the best performance in snowy or icy conditions, you should install snow tires or tire chains. They may be required by local laws under certain conditions. Snow Tires If you mount snow tires on your vehicle, make sure they are radial tires of the same size and load range as original tires. Mount snow tires on all four wheels. The traction provided by snow tires on dry roads may be lower than your original tires. Check with the tire dealer for maximum speed recommendations. CONTINUED 319 Maintenance Tires Tire Chains Mount tire chains on your tires when required by driving conditions or local laws. Install them only on the front tires. Because your vehicle has limited tire clearance, Honda strongly recommends using the chains listed below, made by Security Chain Company (SCC). Cable-type: SCC RADIAL CHAIN SC1030 When installing cables, follow the manufacturer's instructions, and mount them as tight as you can. Make sure they are not contacting the brake lines or suspension. Drive slowly with them installed. If you hear them coming into contact with the body or chassis, stop and investigate. Remove them as soon as you begin driving on cleared roads. Traction devices that are the wrong size or improperly installed can damage your vehicle's brake lines, suspension, body, and wheels. Stop driving if they are hitting any part of the vehicle. Using the wrong chains, or not properly installing chains, can damage the brake lines and cause a crash in which you can be seriously injured or killed. Follow all instructions in this owner's manual regarding the selection and use of tire chains. 320 Checking the 12 Volt Battery TEST INDICATOR WINDOW Check the condition of the 12 volt battery monthly by looking at the test indicator window. The label on the battery explains the test indicator's colors. Check the terminals for corrosion (a white or yellowish powder). To remove it, cover the terminals with a solution of baking soda and water. It will bubble up and turn brown. When this stops, wash it off with plain water. Dry off the battery with a cloth or paper towel. Coat the terminals with grease to help prevent further corrosion. If additional battery maintenance is needed, see your dealer or a qualified technician. WARNING: Battery posts, terminals, and related accessories contain lead and lead compounds. Wash your hands after handling. If you need to connect the battery to a charger, disconnect both cables to prevent damaging your vehicle's electrical system. Always disconnect the negative () cable first, and reconnect it last. The battery gives off explosive hydrogen gas during normal operation. A spark or flame can cause the battery to explode with enough force to kill or seriously hurt you. Wear protective clothing and a face shield, or have a skilled technician do the battery maintenance. If your vehicle's 12 volt battery is disconnected or goes dead, the IMA battery level gauge reading will not be correct the next time you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. It will show less than the actual level temporarily. It will show the correct level after you drive for at least 30 minutes. 321 Maintenance Vehicle Storage If you need to park your vehicle for an extended period (more than 1 month), there are several things you should do to prepare it for storage. Proper preparation helps prevent deterioration and makes it easier to get your vehicle back on the road. If possible, store your vehicle indoors. Fill the fuel tank. Wash and dry the exterior completely. Clean the interior. Make sure the carpeting, floor mats, etc., are completely dry. Leave the parking brake off. Put the transmission in Park. Block the rear wheels. 322 If the vehicle is to be stored for a longer period, it should be supported on jackstands so the tires are off the ground. Leave one window open slightly (if the vehicle is being stored indoors). as plastic sheeting, trap moisture, which can damage the paint. Reconnect the 12 volt battery and drive your vehicle every month for about 30 minutes. This will keep the IMA battery charged and in good condition. Disconnect the 12 volt battery. Support the front wiper blade arms with a folded towel or rag so they do not touch the windshield. To minimize sticking, apply a silicone spray lubricant to all door and trunk seals. Also, apply a vehicle body wax to the painted surfaces that mate with the door and trunk seals. Cover the vehicle with a ``breathable'' cover, one made from a porous material such as cotton. Non-porous materials, such If possible, periodically run the engine until it reaches full operating temperature (the cooling fans cycle on and off twice). Preferably, do this once a month. If this vehicle is unused f or over one month, the service lif e of the 158V Nickel-Metal Hydride battery will be reduced and the battery may be permanently damaged. Taking Care of the Unexpected This section covers the more common problems that motorists experience with their vehicles. It gives you information about how to safely evaluate the problem and what to do to correct it. If the problem has stranded you on the side of the road, you may be able to get going again. If not, you will also find instructions on getting your vehicle towed. Compact Spare Tire....................... 324 Changing a Flat Tire ..................... 325 If the Engine Won't Start.............. 329 Jump Starting ................................. 331 If the Engine Overheats ............... 333 Low Oil Pressure Indicator .......... 335 Charging System Indicator........... 336 Malfunction Indicator Lamp ........ 337 Brake System Indicator ................ 338 Fuses ............................................... 339 Fuse Locations ............................... 343 Emergency Towing ....................... 345 Taking Care of the Unexpected 323 Compact Spare Tire Use the compact spare tire as a temporary replacement only. Get your regular tire repaired or replaced, and put it back on your vehicle as soon as you can. Check the inflation pressure of the compact spare tire every time you check the other tires. It should be inflated to: 60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm ) Follow these precautions: Never exceed 50 mph (80 km/h). This tire gives a harsher ride and less traction on some road surfaces. Use greater caution while driving. Do not mount snow chains on the compact spare tire. Do not use your compact spare tire on another vehicle unless it is the same make and model. On vehicles with the TPMS system, the low tire pressure indicator comes on and stays on after you replace the flat tire with the compact spare tire. After several miles (kilometers) driving with the compact spare tire, the TPMS indicator comes on and the low tire pressure indicator goes off. INDICATOR LOCATION MARK TREAD WEAR INDICATOR BAR Replace the tire when you can see the tread wear indicator bars. The replacement should be the same size and design tire, mounted on the same wheel. The spare tire is not designed to be mounted on a regular wheel, and the spare wheel is not designed for mounting a regular tire. 324 Changing a Flat Tire If you have a flat tire while driving, stop in a safe place to change it. Drive slowly along the shoulder until you get to an exit or an area to stop that is far away from the traffic lanes. The vehicle can easily roll off the jack, seriously injuring anyone underneath. Follow the directions for changing a tire exactly, and never get under the vehicle when it is supported only by the jack. 1. Park the vehicle on firm, level, and non-slippery ground. Put the transmission in Park. Apply the parking brake. 2. Turn on the hazard warning lights, and turn the ignition switch to the LOCK (0) position. Have all passengers get out of the vehicle while you change the tire. JACK TOOL CASE TRUNK FLOOR SPARE TIRE 3. Open the trunk. Raise the trunk floor by lifting up on the back edge. 4. Take the tool case out of the spare tire. 5. Unscrew the wing bolt and take the spare tire out of its well. CONTINUED 325 Taking Care of the Unexpected Changing a Flat Tire JACKING POINTS 6. Remove the center cap from the wheel with the extension. WHEEL NUT WRENCH 7. Loosen each wheel nut 1/2 turn with the wheel nut wrench. 8. Place the jack under the jacking point nearest the tire you need to change. Turn the end bracket clockwise until the top of the jack contacts the jacking point. Make sure the jacking point tab is resting in the jack notch. 326 Changing a Flat Tire 12. Put on the spare tire. Put the wheel nuts back on finger-tight, then tighten them in a crisscross pattern with the wheel nut wrench until the wheel is firmly against the hub. Do not try to tighten the wheel nuts fully. BRAKE HUB 13. Lower the vehicle to the ground, and remove the jack. WHEEL NUT WRENCH EXTENSION 9. Use the extension and the wheel nut wrench as shown to raise the vehicle until the flat tire is off the ground. 10. Remove the wheel nuts, then remove the flat tire. Handle the wheel nuts carefully; they may be hot from driving. Place the flat tire on the ground with the outside surface facing up. 11. Before mounting the spare tire, wipe any dirt off the mounting surface of the wheel and hub with a clean cloth. Wipe the hub carefully; it may be hot from driving. CONTINUED 327 Taking Care of the Unexpected Changing a Flat Tire WING BOLT 18. Store the jack in the tool case. SPACER CONE Loose items can fly around the interior in a crash and could seriously injure the occupants. For For normal spare tire tire 14. Tighten the wheel nuts securely in the same crisscross pattern. Have the wheel nut torque checked at the nearest automotive service facility. Tighten the wheel nuts to: 80 lbf·ft (108 N·m , 11 kgf·m) 15. Place the flat tire face down in the spare tire well. 16. Remove the spacer cone from the wing bolt, turn it over, and put it back on the bolt. 17. Secure the flat tire by screwing the wing bolt back into its hole. Store the wheel, jack, and tools securely before driving. 19. Store the center cap in the trunk. Make sure it does not get scratched or damaged. 20. Lower the trunk floor, then close the trunk lid. 328 If the Engine Won't Start Diagnosing why the engine won't start falls into two areas, depending on what you hear when you turn the ignition switch to the START (III) position: You hear nothing, or almost nothing. The engine's starter motor does not operate at all, or operates very slowly. You can hear the starter motor operating normally, or the starter motor sounds like it is spinning faster than normal, but the engine does not start up and run. Nothing Happens or the Starter Motor Operates Very Slowly When you turn the ignition switch to the START (III) position, you do not hear the normal noise of the engine trying to start. You may hear a clicking sound, a series of clicks, or nothing at all. Check these things: Check the transmission interlock. The transmission must be in Park or neutral or the starter will not operate. Turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. Turn on the headlights, and check their brightness. If the headlights are very dim or do not come on at all, the battery is discharged. See Jump Starting on page 331 . Turn the ignition switch to the START (III) position. If the headlights do not dim, check the condition of the fuses. If the fuses are OK, there is probably something wrong with the electrical circuit for the ignition switch or starter motor. You will need a qualified technician to determine the problem. See Emergency Towing on page 345 . If the headlights dim noticeably or go out when you try to start the engine, either the battery is discharged or the connections are corroded. Check the condition of the 12 volt battery and terminal connections (see page 321 ). You can then try jump starting the vehicle from a booster battery (see page 331 ). Taking Care of the Unexpected 329 If the Engine Won't Start The Starter Operates Normally In this case, the starter motor's speed sounds normal, or even faster than normal, when you turn the ignition switch to the START (III) position, but the engine does not run. Are you using a properly coded key? An improperly coded key will cause the immobilizer system indicator in the instrument panel to blink rapidly (see page 59 ). Are you using the proper starting procedure? Refer to Starting the Engine on page 271 . Do you have fuel? Check the fuel gauge; the low fuel indicator may not be working. There may be an electrical problem, such as no power to the fuel pump. Check all the fuses (see page 339 ). If you find nothing wrong, you will need a qualified technician to find the problem. See Emergency Towing on page 345 . 330 Jump Starting Although this seems like a simple procedure, you should take several precautions. A battery can explode if you do not follow the correct procedure, seriously injuring anyone nearby. Keep all sparks, open flames, and smoking materials away from the battery. You cannot start your vehicle by pushing or pulling it. To jump start your vehicle: 1. Open the hood, and check the physical condition of the 12 volt battery. If a battery sits in extreme cold, the electrolyte inside can f reeze. Attempting to jump start with a f rozen battery can cause it to rupture. 2. Turn off all electrical accessories: heater, A/C, climate control, audio system, lights, etc. Put the transmission in Park, and set the parking brake. BOOSTER BATTERY The numbers in the illustration show you the order to connect the jumper cables. 3. Connect one jumper cable to the positive () terminal on your battery. Connect the other end to the positive () terminal on the booster battery. Taking Care of the Unexpected CONTINUED 331 Jump Starting 6. Start the vehicle. If the starter motor still operates slowly, check that the jumper cables have good metal-to-metal contact. 7. Once your vehicle is running, disconnect the negative cable from your vehicle, then from the booster battery. Disconnect the positive cable from your vehicle, then from the booster battery. If your vehicle's 12 volt battery is disconnected or goes dead, the IMA battery level gauge reading will not be correct the next time you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position. It will show less than the actual level temporarily. It will show the correct level after you drive for at least 30 minutes. 4. Connect the second jumper cable to the negative () terminal on the booster battery. Connect the other end to the grounding strap as shown. Do not connect this jumper cable to any other part of the engine. Keep the ends of the jumper cables away from each other and any metal on the vehicle until everything is disconnected. Otherwise, you may cause an electrical short. 5. If the booster battery is in another vehicle, have an assistant start that vehicle and run it at a fast idle. 332 If the Engine Overheats The reading on the vehicle's temperature gauge should stay in the midrange. If it climbs to the red mark, you should determine the reason (hot day, driving up a steep hill, etc.). When the current fuel mileage is shown on the display, the temperature gauge will interrupt on the display and blink for several times if the coolant temperature rises to 224°F (118°C) or more. At the same time, the beeper sounds once. If your vehicle overheats, you should take immediate action. The only indication may be the temperature gauge climbing to or above the red mark. Or you may see steam or spray coming from under the hood. Driving with the temperature gauge reading at the red mark can cause serious damage to your engine. Steam and spray from an overheated engine can seriously scald you. Do not open the hood if steam is coming out. 1. Safely pull to the side of the road. Put the transmission in Park, and set the parking brake. Turn off all accessories, and turn on the hazard warning lights. 2. If you see steam and/or spray coming from under the hood, turn off the engine. Wait until you see no more signs of steam or spray, then open the hood. 3. If you do not see steam or spray, leave the engine running, and watch the temperature gauge. If the high heat is due to overloading, the engine should start to cool down almost immediately. If it does, wait until the temperature gauge reading comes down to the midpoint, then continue driving. 4. If the temperature gauge stays at the red mark, turn off the engine. Taking Care of the Unexpected CONTINUED 333 If the Engine Overheats 5. Look for any obvious coolant leaks, such as a split radiator hose. Everything is still extremely hot, so use caution. If you find a leak, it must be repaired before you continue driving (see Emergency Towing on page 345 ). 6. If you don't find an obvious leak, check the coolant level in the radiator reserve tank (see page 258 ). Add coolant if the level is below the MIN mark. 7. If there was no coolant in the reserve tank, you may need to add coolant to the radiator. Let the engine cool down until the reading reaches the middle of the temperature gauge or lower before checking the radiator. Removing the radiator cap while the engine is hot can cause the coolant to spray out, seriously scalding you. Always let the engine and radiator cool down before removing the radiator cap. 9. Start the engine, and set the interior temperature to maximum. Add coolant to the radiator up to the base of the filler neck. If you do not have the proper coolant mixture available, you can add plain water. Remember to have the cooling system drained and refilled with the proper mixture as soon as you can. 8. Using gloves or a large heavy cloth, turn the radiator cap counterclockwise, without pushing down, to the first stop. After the pressure releases, push down on the cap, and turn it until it comes off. 10. Put the radiator cap back on tightly. Run the engine, and check the temperature gauge. If it goes back to the red mark, the engine needs repair (see Emergency Towing on page 345 ). 11. If the temperature stays normal, check the coolant level in the radiator reserve tank. If it has gone down, add coolant to the MAX mark. Put the cap back on tightly. 334 Low Oil Pressure Indicator This indicator should never come on when the engine is running. If it starts flashing or stays on, the oil pressure has dropped very low or lost pressure. Serious engine damage is possible, and you should take immediate action. Running the engine with low oil pressure can cause serious mechanical damage almost immediately. Turn of f the engine as soon as you can saf ely get the vehicle stopped. 1. Safely pull off the road, and shut off the engine. Turn on the hazard warning lights. 2. Let the vehicle sit for a minute. Open the hood, and check the oil level (see page 257 ). An engine very low on oil can lose pressure during cornering and other driving maneuvers. 3. If necessary, add oil to bring the level back to the full mark on the dipstick (see page 297 ). 4. Start the engine and watch the oil pressure indicator. If it does not go out within 10 seconds, turn off the engine. There is a mechanical problem that needs to be repaired before you can continue driving (see Emergency Towing on page 345 ). The engine running generates the oil pressure. When the Auto Idle Stop is activated, the engine is stopped, the oil pressure is dropped, and the low oil pressure indicator does not come on. Taking Care of the Unexpected 335 Charging System Indicator If the charging system indicator comes on brightly when the engine is running, the 12 volt battery is not being charged. Immediately turn off all electrical accessories. Try not to use other electrically operated controls such as the power windows. Keep the engine running; starting the engine will discharge the battery rapidly. Go to a service station or garage where you can get technical assistance. If the Auto Idle Stop is active for an extended period, the charging system indicator may come on. If it happens, start the engine. The charging system indicator may also come on if the Integrated Motor Assist (IMA) battery charge drops below a desired level and the engine starts to recharge the battery. This indicator may blink after you start the vehicle in the morning when the temperature is below 20 °F (30°C). It will stop blinking when the IMA battery warms up. 336 Malfunction Indicator Lamp If the indicator comes on while driving, it means one of the engine's emissions control systems may have a problem. Even though you may feel no difference in your vehicle's performance, it can reduce your fuel economy and cause increased emissions. Continued operation may cause serious damage. If you have recently refueled your vehicle, the indicator coming on could be due to a loose or missing fuel fill cap. You will also see a ``CHECK FUEL CAP'' message on the information display. Tighten the cap until it clicks at least once. Tightening the cap will not turn the indicator off immediately; it can take several days of normal driving. If the indicator comes on repeatedly, even though it may turn off as you continue driving, have your vehicle checked by your dealer as soon as possible. If you keep driving with the Malf unction Indicator Lamp on, you can damage your vehicle's emissions controls and engine. Those repairs may not be covered by your vehicle's warranties. This indicator may also come on with the ``D'' indicator. Readiness Code Your vehicle has certain ``readiness codes'' that are part of the on-board diagnostics for the emissions systems. In some states, part of the emissions testing is to make sure these codes are set. If they are not set, the test cannot be completed. If your vehicle's battery has been disconnected or gone dead, these codes are erased. It can take several days of driving under various conditions to set the codes again. To check if they are set, turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position, without starting the engine. The malfunction indicator lamp will come on for 20 seconds. If it then goes off, the readiness codes are set. If it blinks five times, the readiness codes are not set. If possible, do not take your vehicle for an emissions test until the readiness codes are set. Refer to Emissions Testing for more information (see page 360 ). Taking Care of the Unexpected 337 Brake System Indicator U.S. Canada The brake system indicator normally comes on when you turn the ignition switch to the ON (II) position and as a reminder to check the parking brake. It will stay on if you do not fully release the parking brake. If the brake system indicator comes on while driving, the brake fluid level is probably low. Press lightly on the brake pedal to see if it feels normal. If it does, check the brake fluid level the next time you stop at a service station (see page 304 ). If the fluid level is low, take your vehicle to a dealer, and have the brake system inspected for leaks or worn brake pads. However, if the brake pedal does not feel normal, you should take immediate action. A problem in one part of the system's dual circuit design will still give you braking at two wheels. You will feel the brake pedal go down much farther before the vehicle begins to slow down, and you will have to press harder on the pedal. Slow down by shifting to a lower gear, and pull to the side of the road when it is safe. Because of the long distance needed to stop, it is hazardous to drive the vehicle. You should have it towed and repaired as soon as possible (see Emergency Towing on page 345 ). If you must drive the vehicle a short distance in this condition, drive slowly and carefully. If the ABS indicator comes on with the brake system indicator, have your vehicle inspected by your dealer immediately. If the brake system indicator (amber) comes on with the parking brake system indicator (red) with the parking brake released, there may be a malfunction with the power-assist feature. When the power-assist feature malfunctions, the brake indicator (red) comes on and a buzzer sounds for a second. The power-assist feature may stop when the brake effect is weak. Stop your vehicle immediately at a safe place and contact a dealer. 338 INTERIOR UNDER-HOOD (PRIMARY) Fuses UNDER-HOOD (SECONDARY) TAB FUSE LABEL The vehicle's fuses are contained in three fuse boxes. The interior fuse box is underneath the steering column. The primary and secondary underhood fuse boxes are in the engine compartment on the driver's side. Taking Care of the Unexpected 339 Fuses Checking and Replacing Fuses If something electrical in your vehicle stops working, the first thing you should check for is a blown fuse. Determine from the chart on pages 343 and 344 , or the diagram on the fuse box lid, which fuse or fuses control that device. Check those fuses first, but check all the fuses before deciding that a blown fuse is the cause. Replace any blown fuses, and check if the device works. FUSE BLOWN 1. Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK (0) position. Make sure the headlights and all other accessories are off. 2. Remove the cover from the fuse box. BLOWN 3. Check each of the large fuses in the primary under-hood fuse box by looking through the top at the wire inside. Remove the screws with a Phillips-head screwdriver. 340 Fuses FUSE PULLER 4. Check the smaller fuses in the under-hood fuse boxes and all the fuses in the interior fuse box by pulling out each one with the fuse puller provided in the primary under-hood fuse box. BLOWN 5. Look for a blown wire inside the fuse. If it is blown, replace it with one of the spare fuses of the same rating or lower. The spare fuses are provided on the back of the under-hood fuse cover. If you cannot drive the vehicle without fixing the problem, and you do not have a spare fuse, take a fuse of the same rating or a lower rating from one of the other circuits. Make sure you can do without that circuit temporarily (such as the accessory power socket or radio). If you replace the blown fuse with a spare fuse that has a lower rating, it might blow out again. This does not indicate anything wrong. Replace the fuse with one of the correct rating as soon as you can. Taking Care of the Unexpected CONTINUED 341 Fuses Replacing a f use with one that has a higher rating greatly increases the chances of damaging the electrical system. If you do not have a replacement f use with the proper rating f or the circuit, install one with a lower rating. 6. If the replacement fuse of the same rating blows in a short time, there is probably a serious electrical problem with your vehicle. Leave the blown fuse in that circuit, and have your vehicle checked by a qualified technician. When the audio system is disabled, the clock setting in the audio system will be canceled. You will need to reset the clock according to the instructions in the audio system section in this owner's manual. 342 UNDER-HOOD PRIMARY FUSE BOX No. Amps. Circuits Protected 1 100 A 70 A 2 60 A 50 A 3 30 A 40 A Main Fuse EPS Option Main Ignition Switch Main ABS Motor ABS F/S No. Amps. Circuits Protected 4 50 A 40 A 5 40 A 6 20 A 7 20 A 8 30 A 9 40 A 10 10 A 11 15 A 12 15 A 13 15 A 14 15 A 15 7.5 A 16 17 18 20 A 19 15 A 20 7.5 A 21 15 A 22 7.5 A 23 10 A Headlight Main Power Window Main Booster Motor Sub Fan Motor Main Fan Motor Rear Defogger Blower Hazard FI Sub Stop and Horn IG Coil (EX) IG Coil (IN) Oil Level Not Used Not Used IG Coil FI Main MG Clutch DBW Interior Light Back Up Fuse Locations UNDER-HOOD SECONDARY FUSE BOX No. Amps. Circuits Protected 1 10 A 2 7.5 A 3 15 A IMA2 IMA1 Booster MS Taking Care of the Unexpected 343 Fuse Locations INTERIOR FUSE BOX No. Amps. Circuits Protected 1 7.5 A 2 15 A 3 10 A 4 7.5 A 5 15 A 6 7 7.5 A 8 Power Window Fuel Pump IG1 ACG ABS/VSA Unit Seat Heater Not Used TPMS Not Used 344 No. Amps. Circuits Protected 9 7.5 A 10 7.5 A 11 10 A 12 10 A 13 10 A 14 7.5 A 15 7.5 A 16 10 A ODS METER SRS Right Headlight High Beam Left Headlight High Beam Small (Interior) Small (Exterior) Right Headlight Low Beam No. Amps. Circuits Protected 17 10 A 18 20 A 19 15 A Left Headlight Low Beam Headlight High Main Small (Main) 20 21 20 A 22 (7.5 A) 23 (7.5 A) Not Used Headlight Low Main (HAC) STS 24 25 20 A 26 20 A 27 28 (15 A) 29 15 A 30 20 A 31 32 20 A 33 20 A 34 35 7.5 A 36 10 A 37 7.5 A 38 30 A Not Used Door Lock Driver's Power Window Not Used Rear ACC Socket ACC Passenger's Power Window Not Used Right Rear Power Window Left Rear Power Window Not Used ACC, Radio HAC Daytime Running Light Wiper : Optional in U.S. Emergency Towing If your vehicle needs to be towed, call a professional towing service or organization. Never tow your vehicle with just a rope or chain. It is very dangerous. There are two ways to tow your vehicle: Flat-bed Equipment The operator loads your vehicle on the back of a truck. This is the best way to transport your vehicle. Wheel-lift Equipment The tow truck uses two pivoting arms that go under the tires (front) and lift them off the ground. The other two tires remain on the ground. This is an acceptable way to tow your vehicle. If, due to damage, your vehicle must be towed with the front wheels on the ground, do this: Start the engine. Press on the brake pedal. Move the shift lever through all its positions. Shift to D position for 5 seconds, then to N. Turn off the engine. Release the parking brake. Leave the ignition switch in the ACCESSORY (I) position so the steering wheel does not lock. Improper towing preparation will damage the transmission. Follow the above procedure exactly. If you cannot shif t the transmission or start the engine, your vehicle must be transported with the f ront wheels of f the ground. With the front wheels on the ground, it is best to tow the vehicle no farther than 50 miles (80 km), and keep the speed below 35 mph (55 km/h). Taking Care of the Unexpected CONTINUED 345 Emergency Towing Trying to lif t or tow your vehicle by the bumpers will cause serious damage. The bumpers are not designed to support the vehicle's weight. The steering system can be damaged if the steering wheel is locked. Leave the ignition switch in the ACCESSORY (I) position, and make sure the steering wheel turns f reely bef ore you begin towing. 346 Technical Information The diagrams in this section give you the dimensions and capacities of your vehicle and the locations of the identification numbers. It also includes information you should know about your vehicle's tires and emissions control systems. Identification Numbers................. 348 Specifications ................................. 350 DOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles) ....................... 352 Uniform Tire Quality Grading ................................... 352 Treadwear .................................. 352 Traction....................................... 352 Temperature .............................. 353 Tire Labeling.................................. 353 Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Required Federal Explanation............................. 355 Emissions Controls........................ 357 The Clean Air Act...................... 357 Crankcase Emissions Control System..................................... 357 Evaporative Emissions Control System..................................... 357 Onboard Refueling Vapor Recovery ................................. 357 Exhaust Emissions Controls .... 358 PGM-FI System ..................... 358 Ignition Timing Control System................................. 358 Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) System.................... 358 Three Way Catalytic Converter............................ 358 Replacement Parts..................... 358 Three Way Catalytic Converter... 359 Emissions Testing ......................... 360 Technical Information 347 Identification Numbers Your vehicle has several identifying numbers in various places. The vehicle identification number (VIN) is the 17-digit number your dealer uses to register your vehicle for warranty purposes. It is also necessary for licensing and insuring your vehicle. The easiest place to find the VIN is on a plate fastened to the top of the dashboard. You can see it by looking through the windshield on the driver's side. It is also on the certification label attached to the driver's doorjamb, and is stamped on the engine compartment bulkhead. The VIN is also provided in bar code on the certification label. The VIN is also located on the engine bulkhead. Slide the cover on the engine compartment bulkhead to view the VIN. Always close the cover when finished. 348 COVER VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER (VIN) CERTIFICATION LABEL The engine number is stamped into the engine block. The transmission number is on a label on top of the transmission. The IMA Motor Number is stamped on the motor housing. IMA MOTOR NUMBER Identification Numbers ENGINE NUMBER TRANSMISSION NUMBER 349 Technical Information Specif ications Dimensions Length Width Height Wheelbase Track Front Rear Weights Gross vehicle weight rating Seating Capacities Total Front Rear Engine Type Bore x Stroke Displacement Compression ratio Spark plugs 176.7 in (4,489 mm) 69.0 in (1,752 mm) 56.3 in (1,430 mm) 106.3 in (2,700 mm) 59.1 in (1,501 mm) 60.2 in (1,529 mm) See the certification label attached to the driver's doorjamb. 5 2 3 Water cooled 4-stroke SOHC i-VTEC gasoline engine with Hybrid Electric 2.87 x 3.15 in (73.0 x 80.0 mm) 82 cu-in (1,339 cm ) 10.8 ILFR6J-11K (NGK) SK20HPR-L11 (DENSO) Capacities Fuel tank Engine coolant Engine oil Automatic transmission fluid Windshield washer reservoir Change1 Total Change2 Including filter Without filter Total Change Total U.S. Vehicles Canada Vehicles Approx. 12.3 US gal (46.6 ) 1.255 US gal (4.75 ) 1.59 US gal (6.0 ) 3.4 US qt (3.2 ) 3.2 US qt (3.0 ) 4.0 US qt (3.8 ) 3.0 US qt (2.8 ) 5.4 US qt (5.1 ) 2.6 US qt (2.5 ) 4.8 US qt (4.5 ) 1 : Including the coolant in the reserve tank and that remaining in the engine Reserve tank capacity: 0.11 US gal (0.4 ) 2 : Excluding the oil remaining in the engine 350 Air Conditioning Refrigerant type Charge quantity Lubricant oil type Lights Headlights High Low Front turn signal/side marker lights Rear turn signal lights Brake/Taillights (in fenders) Back-up lights Rear side marker lights Taillights (in trunk lid) License plate lights Ceiling light Spotlights Trunk light 12 Volt Battery Capacity HFC-134a (R-134a) 14.115.9 oz (400450 g) SE-10Y 12 V 60 W (HB3) 12 V 51 W (HB4) 12 V 24/2.2 CP 12 V 21 W 12 V 21/5 W 12 V 21 W 12 V 2 CP 12 V 3 CP 12 V 5 W 12 V 8 W 12 V 8 W 12 V 5 W 12 V 35 AH/20 HR 12 V 28 AH/5 HR Specif ications Fuses Interior Under-hood Alignment Toe-in Camber Caster Tires Size Pressure Front Rear Front Rear Front Front/Rear Spare Front/Rear Spare See page 339 or the fuse label attached to the inside of the fuse box door under the steering column. See page 339 or the fuse box cover. 0.00 in (0.0 mm) 2.0 in (2.0 mm) 0°3' 1°39' 7°6' P195/65R15 89S T135/80D15 99M 32 psi (220 kPa , 2.2 kgf/cm ) 60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm ) Technical Information 351 DOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles) The tires on your vehicle meet all U.S. Federal Safety Requirements. All tires are also graded for treadwear, traction, and temperature performance according to Department of Transportation (DOT) standards. The following explains these gradings. Uniform Tire Quality Grading Quality grades can be found where applicable on the tire sidewall between tread shoulder and maximum section width. For example: Treadwear 200 Traction AA Temperature A All passenger car tires must conform to Federal Safety Requirements in addition to these grades. Treadwear The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a specified government test course. For example, a tire graded 150 would wear one and onehalf (1 1/2) times as well on the government course as a tire graded 100. The relative performance of tires depends upon the actual conditions of their use, however, and may depart significantly from the norm due to variations in driving habits, service practices and differences in road characteristics and climate. Traction The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B, and C. Those grades represent the tire's ability to stop on wet pavement as measured under controlled conditions on specified government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor traction performance. Warning: The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on straight-ahead braking traction tests, and does not include acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning, or peak traction characteristics. 352 DOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles), Tire Labeling Temperature The temperature grades are A (the highest), B, and C, representing the tire's resistance to the generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause the material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life, and excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of performance which all passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B and A represent higher levels of performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum required by law. Warning: The temperature grade for this tire is established for a tire that is properly inflated and not overloaded. Excessive speed, underinflation, or excessive loading, either separately or in combination, can cause heat buildup and possible tire failure. Tire Labeling The tires that came on your vehicle have a number of markings. Those you should be aware of are described below. TIRE LABELING EXAMPLE (1) (1) (4) (3) (2) (1) Tire Size (2) Tire Identification Number (TIN) (3) Maximum Tire Pressure (4) Maximum Tire Load CONTINUED 353 Technical Information Tire Labeling Tire Size Whenever tires are replaced, they should be replaced with tires of the same size. The following is an example of tire size with an explanation of what each component means. P195/65R15 89S P Vehicle type (P indicates passenger vehicle). 195 Tire width in millimeters. 65 Aspect ratio (the tire's section height as a percentage of its width). R Tire construction code (R indicates radial). 15 Rim diameter in inches. 89 Load index (a numerical code associated with the maximum load the tire can carry). S Speed symbol (an alphabetical code indicating the maximum speed rating). Tire Identification Number (TIN) The tire identification number (TIN) is a group of numbers and letters that look like the following example. TIN is located on the sidewall of the tire. DOT B97R FW6X 2202 DOT This indicates that the tire meets all requirements of the U.S. Department of Transportation. B97R Manufacturer's identification mark. FW6X Tire type code. 2202 Date of manufacture. Year Week Maximum Tire Pressure Max Press The maximum air pressure the tire can hold. Maximum Tire Load Max Load The maximum load the tire can carry at maximum air pressure. 354 Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Required Federal Explanation U.S. models only Each tire, including the spare (if provided), should be checked monthly when cold and inflated to the inflation pressure recommended by the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label. (If your vehicle has tires of a different size than the size indicated on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label, you should determine the proper tire inflation pressure for those tires.) As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been equipped with a tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure telltale when one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated. Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you should stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate them to the proper pressure. Technical Information CONTINUED 355 Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Required Federal Explanation Driving on a significantly underinflated tire causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle's handling and stopping ability. Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS malfunction indicator to indicate when the system is not operating properly. The TPMS malfunction indicator is provided by a separate telltale, which displays the symbol ``TPMS'' when illuminated. Always check the TPMS malfunction telltale after replacing one or more tires or wheels on your vehicle to ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the TPMS to continue to function properly. Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire maintenance, and it is the driver's responsibility to maintain correct tire pressure, even if under-inflation has not reached the level to trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure telltale. When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the system may not be able to detect or signal low tire pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety of reasons, including the installation of replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the TPMS from functioning properly. 356 Emissions Controls The burning of gasoline in your vehicle's engine produces several byproducts. Some of these are carbon monoxide (CO), oxides of nitrogen (NOx), and hydrocarbons (HC). Gasoline evaporating from the tank also produces hydrocarbons. Controlling the production of NOx, CO, and HC is important to the environment. Under certain conditions of sunlight and climate, NOx and HC react to form photochemical ``smog.'' Carbon monoxide does not contribute to smog creation, but it is a poisonous gas. The Clean Air Act The United States Clean Air Act sets standards for automobile emissions. It also requires that automobile manufacturers explain to owners how their emissions controls work and what to do to maintain them. This section summarizes how the emissions controls work. In Canada, Honda vehicles comply with the Canadian emission requirements, as specified in an agreement with Environment Canada, at the time they are manufactured. Crankcase Emissions Control System Your vehicle has a positive crankcase ventilation system. This keeps gasses that build up in the engine's crankcase from going into the atmosphere. The positive crankcase ventilation valve routes them from the crankcase back to the intake manifold. They are then drawn into the engine and burned. Evaporative Emissions Control System As gasoline evaporates in the fuel tank, an evaporative emissions control canister filled with charcoal adsorbs the vapor. It is stored in this canister while the engine is off. After the engine is started and warmed up, the vapor is drawn into the engine and burned during driving. Onboard Refueling Vapor Recovery The onboard refueling vapor recovery (ORVR) system captures the fuel vapors during refueling. The vapors are adsorbed in a canister filled with activated carbon. While driving, the fuel vapors are drawn into the engine and burned off. 357 Technical Information Emissions Controls Exhaust Emissions Controls The exhaust emissions controls include four systems: PGM-FI, ignition timing control, exhaust gas recirculation, and three way catalytic converter. These four systems work together to control the engine's combustion and minimize the amount of HC, CO, and NOx that come out the tailpipe. The exhaust emissions control systems are separate from the crankcase and evaporative emissions control systems. PGM-FI System The PGM-FI system uses sequential multiport fuel injection. It has three subsystems: air intake, engine control, and fuel control. The powertrain control module (PCM) uses various sensors to determine how much air is going into the engine. It then controls how much fuel to inject under all operating conditions. Ignition Timing Control System This system constantly adjusts the ignition timing, reducing the amount of HC, CO, and NOx produced. Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) System The exhaust gas recirculation (EGR) system takes some of the exhaust gas and routes it back into the intake manifold. Adding exhaust gas to the air/fuel mixture reduces the amount of NOx produced when the fuel is burned. Three Way Catalytic Converter The three way catalytic converter is in the exhaust system. Through chemical reactions, it converts HC, CO, and NOx in the engine's exhaust to carbon dioxide (CO2), nitrogen (N2), and water vapor. Replacement Parts The emissions control systems are designed and certified to work together in reducing emissions to levels that comply with the Clean Air Act. To make sure the emissions remain low, you should use only new Honda replacement parts or their equivalent for repairs. Using lower quality parts may increase the emissions from your vehicle. The emissions control systems are covered by warranties separate from the rest of your vehicle. Read your warranty manual for more information. 358 Three Way Catalytic Converter The three way catalytic converter contains precious metals that serve as catalysts, promoting chemical reactions to convert the exhaust gasses without affecting the metals. The catalytic converter is referred to as a three-way catalyst, since it acts on HC, CO, and NOx. A replacement unit must be an original Honda part or its equivalent. The three way catalytic converter must operate at a high temperature for the chemical reactions to take place. It can set on fire any combustible materials that come near it. Park your vehicle away from high grass, dry leaves, or other flammables. THREE WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTERS U.S. model is shown A defective three way catalytic converter contributes to air pollution, and can impair your engine's performance. Follow these guidelines to protect your vehicle's three way catalytic converter. Always use unleaded gasoline. Even a small amount of leaded gasoline can contaminate the catalyst metals, making the three way catalytic converter ineffective. Keep the engine well maintained. Have your vehicle diagnosed and repaired if it is misfiring, backfiring, stalling, or otherwise not running properly. Technical Information 359 Emissions Testing Testing of Readiness Codes If you take your vehicle for an emissions test shortly after the battery has been disconnected or gone dead, it may not pass the test. This is because of certain ``readiness codes'' that must be set in the onboard diagnostics for the emissions systems. These codes are erased when the battery is disconnected, and set again only after several days of driving under a variety of conditions. If the testing facility determines that the readiness codes are not set, you will be requested to return at a later date to complete the test. If you must get the vehicle retested within the next two or three days, you can condition the vehicle for retesting by doing the following. 1. Make sure the gas tank is nearly, but not completely, full (around 3/4). 2. Make sure the vehicle has been parked with the engine off for 6 hours or more. 4. Without touching the accelerator pedal, start the engine, and let it idle for 20 seconds. 5. Keep the vehicle in Park. Increase the engine speed to 2,000 rpm, and hold it there until the temperature gauge rises to at least 1/4 of the scale (about 3 minutes). 6. Without touching the accelerator pedal, let the engine idle for 20 seconds. 3. Make sure the ambient temperature is between 40° and 95°F (4° and 35°C). 360 7. Select a nearby lightly traveled major highway where you can maintain a speed of 50 to 60 mph (80 to 97 km/h) for at least 20 minutes. Drive on the highway in D. Do not use the cruise control. When traffic allows, drive for 90 seconds without moving the accelerator pedal. (Vehicle speed may vary slightly; this is okay.) If you cannot do this for a continuous 90 seconds because of traffic conditions, drive for at least 30 seconds, then repeat it two more times (for a total of 90 seconds). 8. Then drive in city/suburban traffic for at least 10 minutes. When traffic conditions allow, let the vehicle coast for several seconds without using the accelerator pedal or the brake pedal. 9. Make sure the vehicle has been parked with the engine off for 30 minutes. If the testing facility determines the readiness codes are still not set, see your dealer. Emissions Testing Technical Information 361 362 Warranty and Customer Relations Customer Service Information..... 364 Warranty Coverages ..................... 365 Reporting Safety Defects (U.S. Vehicles) ........................... 366 Authorized Manuals ...................... 367 Warranty and Customer Relations 363 Customer Service Information Honda dealership personnel are trained professionals. They should be able to answer all your questions. If you encounter a problem that your dealership does not solve to your satisfaction, please discuss it with the dealership's management. The service manager or general manager can help. Almost all problems are solved in this way. If you are dissatisfied with the decision made by the dealership's management, contact Honda Customer Service. U.S. Owners: American Honda Motor Co., Inc. Honda Automobile Customer Service Mail Stop 500-2N-7A 1919 Torrance Boulevard Torrance, California 90501-2746 Tel: (800) 999-1009 Canadian Owners: Customer Relations Honda Canada Inc. 715 Milner Avenue Toronto, ON M1B 2K8 Tel: 1-888-9-HONDA-9 Fax: Toll-free 1-877-939-0909 Toronto (416) 287-4776 In Puerto Rico and the U.S. Virgin Islands: Bella International P.O. Box 190816 San Juan, PR 00919-0816 Tel: (787) 620-7546 When you call or write, please give us this information: Vehicle Identification Number (see page 348 ) Name and address of the dealer who services your vehicle Date of purchase Mileage on your vehicle Your name, address, and telephone number A detailed description of the problem Name of the dealer who sold the vehicle to you 364 Warranty and Customer Relations Warranty Coverages U.S. Owners Your new vehicle is covered by these warranties: New Vehicle Limited Warranty covers your new vehicle, except for the battery, emissions control systems, and accessories, against defects in materials and workmanship. Emissions Control Systems Defects Warranty and Emissions Performance Warranty these two warranties cover your vehicle's emissions control systems. Time, mileage, and coverage are conditional. Please read your warranty booklet for exact information. Original Equipment Battery Limited Warranty this warranty gives up to 100% credit toward a replacement battery. Seat Belt Limited Warranty a seat belt that fails to function properly is covered by a limited warranty. Please read your warranty booklet for details. Rust Perforation Limited Warranty all exterior body panels are covered for rust-through from the inside for the specified time period with no mileage limit. Accessory Limited Warranty Honda accessories are covered under this warranty. Time and mileage limits depend on the type of accessory and other factors. Please read your warranty booklet for details. Replacement Parts Limited Warranty covers all Honda replacement parts against defects in materials and workmanship. Replacement Battery Limited Warranty provides prorated coverage for a replacement battery purchased from your dealer. Replacement Muffler Lifetime Limited Warranty provides coverage for as long as the purchaser of the muffler owns the vehicle. Restrictions and exclusions apply to all these warranties. Please read the 2009 Honda warranty information booklet that came with your vehicle for precise information on warranty coverages. Your vehicle's original tires are covered by their manufacturer. Tire warranty information is in a separate booklet. Canadian Owners Please refer to the 2009 warranty manual that came with your vehicle. 365 Reporting Safety Defects (U.S. Vehicles) If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death, you should immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) in addition to notifying American Honda Motor Co., Inc. If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved in individual problems between you, your dealer, or American Honda Motor Co., Inc. To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153); go to http://www.saf ercar.gov; or write to: Administrator, NHTSA, 1200 New Jersey Avenue, SE., Washington, DC 20590. You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from http://www.saf ercar.gov. 366 Authorized Manuals Purchasing Factory Authorized Manuals (U.S. only) The publications shown below can be purchased from Helm Incorporated. You can order by phone or online: Call Helm Inc. at 1-800-782-4356 (credit card orders only) Go online at www. helminc. com If you are interested in other years or models, contact Helm Inc. at 1-800-782-4356. Publication Form Number 61SNC03 61SNC03EL 61SNA30 31SNC630 31SNC820 31SNCM30 31SNCQ30 HON-R Form Description 2006-2009 Honda Civic Hybrid Service Manual 2006-2009 Honda Civic Hybrid Electrical Troubleshooting Manual 2006-2009 Model Series Honda Civic 2/4 Door Body Repair Manual 2009 Honda Civic Hybrid Owner's Manual 2009 Honda Civic Hybrid Navigation System Owner's Manual 2009 Honda Civic Hybrid Honda Service History 2009 Honda Civic Hybrid Quick Start Guide Order Form for Previous YearsIndicate Year and Model Desired Service Manual: Covers maintenance and recommended procedures for repair to engine and chassis components. It is written for the journeyman mechanic, but it is simple enough for most mechanically inclined owners to understand. Electrical Troubleshooting Manual: Complements the Service Manual by providing in-depth troubleshooting information for each electrical circuit in your vehicle. Body Repair Manual: Describes the procedures involved in the replacement of damaged body parts. Authorized Manuals 367 368 Index A Accessories..................................... 263 ACCESSORY (Ignition Key Position)........................................ 80 Accessory Power Socket .............. 101 Additives, Engine Oil..................... 297 Airbag (SRS) ................................ 9, 21 Airbags, Additional Information .... 21 Additional Safety Precautions.... 32 Advanced Airbag System ........... 26 Airbag Service.............................. 32 How the Passenger Airbag Off Indicator Works....................... 31 How the Side Airbag Off Indicator Works....................... 30 How the SRS Indicator Works ... 30 How Your Front Airbags Work.......................................... 24 How Your Side Airbags Work.... 28 How Your Side Curtain Airbags Work.......................................... 29 SRS Components ......................... 21 Air Conditioning System............... 104 Air Pressure, Tires ........................ 315 Antifreeze ....................................... 300 Anti-lock Brakes (ABS) Indicator................................ 59, 280 Operation .................................... 280 Anti-theft, Audio System............... 209 Anti-theft Steering Column Lock........................................... 80 Armrest ......................................... 95 Audio System ................................. 110 Auto Door Locking/Unlocking...... 83 Auto Door Locking.......................... 82 Auto Door Unlocking ...................... 85 Auto Idle Stop......................... 276, 277 Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners .... 19 Automatic Speed Control.............. 214 Automatic Transmission (CVT) .. 272 Capacity, Fluid ........................... 350 Checking Fluid Level ................ 303 Shifting........................................ 273 Shift Lever Position Indicators................................ 272 Shift Lever Positions ................. 273 Shift Lock Release..................... 275 B Battery Charging System Indicator............................ 62, 336 Jump Starting ............................. 331 Maintenance............................... 321 Specifications ............................. 350 Before Driving ............................... 253 Belts, Seat ..................................... 8, 18 Beverage Holder............................ 100 Brakes Anti-lock System (ABS)............ 280 Break-in, New Linings .............. 254 Bulb Replacement ..................... 308 Fluid ............................................ 304 Pad Wear Indicator.................... 280 Parking.......................................... 99 System Indicator............ 58, 63, 338 Braking System.............................. 279 Break-in, New Vehicle .................. 254 Brightness Control, Instruments... 75 CONTINUED I INDEX Index Bulb Replacement Back-up Lights ........................... 309 Brake Lights ...................... 308, 309 Front Side Marker Lights......... 307 Front Turn Signal Light............ 307 Headlights .................................. 305 Parking Lights ........................... 307 Rear Side Marker Lights .......... 308 Rear Turn Signal Lights ........... 308 Specifications ............................. 351 Bulbs, Halogen............................... 305 C Card, PC.......................................... 170 Capacities Chart............................. 350 Carbon Monoxide Hazard .............. 52 Carrying Cargo .............................. 264 CAUTION, Explanation of .............. iii Ceiling Light................................... 102 Certification Label ......................... 348 Chains ............................................. 320 Changing a Flat Tire ..................... 325 Changing Oil How to......................................... 298 When to....................................... 289 Charging System Indicator .... 62, 336 Check Fuel Cap Indicator............... 69 Checklist, Before Driving............. 270 Child Safety ...................................... 34 Child Seats LATCH Anchor System.............. 43 Lower Anchor .............................. 43 Tether Anchor ............................. 47 Childproof Door Locks ................... 82 Cleaning the Wheels ..................... 315 Clock, Setting the .......................... 212 CO in the Exhaust ......................... 357 Cold Weather, Starting in ............. 271 Compact Spare ............................... 324 Controls, Instruments and.............. 55 Coolant Adding......................................... 300 Checking..................................... 258 Proper Solution .......................... 300 Temperature Gauge .................... 66 Crankcase Emissions Control System......................................... 357 Cruise Control Operation ............. 214 Customer Service Information..... 364 D DANGER, Explanation of ................ iii Dashboard .................................... 3, 56 Daytime Running Lights................. 75 Defects, Reporting Safety............. 366 Defog and Defrost ......................... 108 Defogger, Rear Window ................. 76 Defrosting the Windows............... 108 Dimensions..................................... 350 Dimming the Headlights ................ 74 Dipstick Automatic Transmission........... 303 Engine Oil................................... 257 Directional Signals........................... 74 Disc Brake Pad Wear Indicators.................................... 280 Disc Player ............................. 122, 160 Display Change Button ................... 66 Disposal of Used Oil...................... 300 Doors Auto Door Locking/Unlocking.. 82 Auto Door Locking...................... 82 Auto Door Unlocking .................. 85 Locking and Unlocking............... 81 Power Door Locks....................... 81 II Index DOT Tire Quality Grading ......... 352 Driver and Passenger Safety............ 5 Driving ............................................ 269 Economy ..................................... 259 Dust and Pollen Filter ................... 312 E Economy, Fuel ............................... 259 Emergencies on the Road............. 323 Battery, Jump Starting .............. 331 Brake System Indicator ............ 338 Changing a Flat Tire ................. 325 Charging System Indicator ...... 337 Checking the Fuses................... 340 Low Oil Pressure Indicator............................ 62, 335 Malfunction Indicator Lamp ................................. 62, 337 Overheated Engine ................... 333 Emergency Brake............................ 99 Emergency Flashers ....................... 76 Emergency Towing ....................... 345 Emergency Trunk Opener ............. 88 Emissions Controls........................ 357 Emissions Testing ......................... 360 Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge ..... 66 Engine Speed Limiter ............... 274 Malfunction Indicator Lamp ................................. 62, 337 Oil Pressure Indicator......... 62, 335 Oil, What Kind to Use ............... 297 Overheating................................ 333 Specifications ............................. 350 Starting........................................ 271 Evaporative Emissions Controls.. 357 Exhaust Fumes ................................ 52 Expectant Mothers, Use of Seat Belts by ......................................... 16 F Fan, Interior.................................... 105 Features .......................................... 103 Filling the Fuel Tank..................... 255 Filters Dust and Pollen.......................... 312 Oil ................................................ 298 Flashers, Hazard Warning.............. 76 Flat Tire, Changing a .................... 325 Fluids Automatic Transmission........... 303 Brake........................................... 304 Windshield Washer ................... 302 FM Stereo Radio Reception .................................... 204 Four-way Flashers ........................... 76 Front Airbags ............................... 9, 21 Fuel.................................................. 254 Fill Door and Cap....................... 255 Gauge ............................................ 66 Octane Requirement ................. 254 Oxygenated ................................ 254 Reserve Indicator......................... 61 Tank, Filling the......................... 255 Fuses, Checking the...................... 340 G Gas Mileage, Improving................ 259 Gasohol ........................................... 254 CONTINUED III INDEX Index Gasoline .......................................... 254 Fuel Reserve Indicator................ 61 Gauge ............................................ 66 Octane Requirement ................. 254 Tank, Filling the......................... 255 Gas Station Procedures................. 255 Gauges Engine Coolant Temperature .... 66 Fuel................................................ 67 Gearshift Lever Positions............. 272 Automatic Transmission........... 272 Glove Box ....................................... 101 H Halogen Headlight Bulbs.............. 305 Hazard Warning Flashers............... 76 Headlights Aiming......................................... 305 Daytime Running Lights............. 75 High Beam Indicator................... 60 Reminder Beeper......................... 74 Replacing Halogen Bulbs ......... 305 Turning on.................................... 74 Head Restraints ............................... 92 Heated Mirrors ................................ 99 Heaters, Seat .................................... 96 High Altitude, Starting at.............. 271 High-Low Beam Switch .................. 74 Hood, Opening the ........................ 256 Horn................................................... 72 I Identification Number, Vehicle.... 348 Ignition Keys............................................... 78 Switch............................................ 80 Timing Control System............. 358 Important Safety Precautions .......... 6 Indicators, Instrument Panel.......... 58 Infant Restraint ................................ 39 Infant Seats LATCH Anchorage System ....... 43 Lower Anchors ............................ 43 Tether Anchors............................ 47 Inflation, Recommended Tire ...... 316 Pressures .................................... 316 Information Display......................... 65 Inside Mirror .................................... 98 Inspection, Tire .............................. 317 Instrument Panel ............................. 57 Instrument Panel Lights ................. 58 Instrument Panel Brightness ......... 75 Interior Lights ................................ 102 Introduction......................................... i iPod ........................................ 130, 183 J Jacking up the Vehicle .................. 326 Jack, Tire ........................................ 325 Jump Starting ................................. 331 K Keys................................................... 78 L Label, Certification ........................ 348 Lane Change, Signaling .................. 74 Lap/Shoulder Belts ................... 14, 18 LATCH Anchorage System............ 43 IV Index Lights Bulb Replacement ..................... 305 Indicator........................................ 60 Parking.......................................... 74 Turn Signal ................................... 74 Load Limits..................................... 265 LOCK (Ignition Key Position) ....... 80 Locks Anti-theft Steering Column ........ 80 Fuel Fill Door ............................. 256 Power Door .................................. 81 Trunk ............................................ 88 Low Coolant Level......................... 258 Low Fuel Indicator .......................... 61 Lower Anchors................................. 43 Low Oil Pressure Indicator .... 62, 335 Lubricant Specifications Chart .... 350 M Maintenance................................... 287 Minder......................................... 289 Minder Indicator.......................... 61 Owner's Maintenance Checks .................................... 294 Safety........................................... 288 Malfunction Indicator Lamp .. 62, 337 Meters, Gauges.......................... 57, 65 Methanol in Gasoline .................... 255 Mirrors, Adjusting ........................... 98 MP3/WMA ............................ 122, 161 N Neutral Gear Position.................... 274 New Vehicle Break-in ................... 254 NOTICE, Explanation of.................... i Numbers, Identification................ 348 O Octane Requirement, Gasoline.... 254 Odometer.......................................... 69 Odometer,Trip ................................. 67 Oil Change, How to ......................... 298 Change, When to ....................... 289 Checking Engine ....................... 256 Pressure Indicator ............... 62, 335 Selecting Proper Viscosity........ 297 ON (Ignition Key Position) ............ 80 Onboard Refueling Vapor Recovery ..................................... 357 Outside Mirrors ............................... 98 Outside Temperature Indicator..... 67 Overheating, Engine ..................... 333 Owner's Maintenance Checks ..... 294 Oxygenated Fuels.......................... 255 P Panel Brightness Control ............... 75 Park Gear Position......................... 274 Parking............................................ 278 Parking Brake .................................. 99 Parking Brake and Brake System Indicator.................. 58, 338 Parking Lights.................................. 74 Parking Over Things that Burn... 278 PGM-FI System.............................. 358 Playing the Radio................... 113, 148 Playing a Disc......................... 122, 160 Playing a PC Card.......................... 170 Pregnancy, Using Seat Belts .......... 16 CONTINUED V INDEX Index Protecting Adults and Teens.......... 11 Additional Safety Precautions.... 17 Advice for Pregnant Women...... 16 Protecting Children ......................... 34 Protecting Infants........................ 39 Protecting Larger Children ........ 48 Protecting Small Children .......... 40 R Radiator Overheating.................... 333 Radio/Disc/Sound System .. 112, 147 Readiness Codes.................... 337, 360 Rear Lights, Bulb Replacement....................... 308, 309 Rear View Mirror............................. 98 Rear Window Defogger .................. 76 Reclining the Seat-backs................. 91 Remote Transmitter........................ 89 Replacement Information Dust and Pollen Filter ............... 312 Engine Oil and Filter ................. 298 Fuses ........................................... 340 Light Bulbs ................................. 305 Maintenance Minder................. 389 Tires ............................................ 315 Wiper Blades.............................. 312 Replacing Seat Belts After a Crash ............................................. 20 Reserve Tank, Engine Coolant................................ 258, 300 Restraint, Child ................................ 34 Reverse Gear Position................... 274 Rotation, Tire ................................. 318 S Safety Belts................................... 8, 18 Safety Defects, Reporting............. 366 Safety Features .................................. 7 Airbags............................................ 9 Seat Belts ........................................ 8 Safety Labels, Location of .............. 53 Safety Messages ............................... iii Seat Belts ...................................... 8, 18 Additional Information................ 18 Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners................................ 19 Lap/Shoulder Belt................. 14, 18 Maintenance......................... 20, 311 Reminder Light and Beeper................................. 18, 58 System Components.................... 18 Use During Pregnancy................ 16 Wearing a Lap/Shoulder Belt ...................................... 14, 18 Seat Heaters ..................................... 96 Seats, Adjusting the......................... 91 Security System ............................. 213 Serial Number ................................ 348 Service Intervals ............................ 295 Service Manual .............................. 367 Service Station Procedures .......... 255 Setting the Clock ........................... 212 Shift Lever Position Indicators .... 272 Shift Lock Release......................... 275 Side Airbags ................................. 9, 28 Off Indicator........................... 30, 59 Side Curtain Airbags ....................... 29 Side Marker Lights, Bulb Replacement............................... 307 Signaling Turns................................ 74 Snow Tires...................................... 319 Spare Tire Inflating....................................... 324 Specifications ............................. 351 Specifications Charts..................... 350 Speed Control................................. 214 VI Index Speed-Sensitive Volume Compensation (SVC) ........ 115, 158 Spotlights ........................................ 102 SRS, Additional Information........... 21 Additional Safety Precautions.... 32 Airbag Service.............................. 32 How the Passenger Airbag Off Indicator Works....................... 31 How the Side Airbag Off Indicator Works....................... 30 How the SRS Indicator Works ... 30 How Your Front Airbags Work.......................................... 24 How Your Side Airbags Work.... 28 How Your Side Curtain Airbags Work........................... 29 SRS Components ......................... 21 SRS Indicator.............................. 30, 59 START (Ignition Key Position) ..... 80 Starting the Engine........................ 271 In Cold Weather at High Altitude ................................... 271 With a Dead Battery ................. 331 Steam Coming from Engine......... 333 Steering Wheel Adjustment ................................... 77 Anti-theft Column Lock .............. 80 Storing Your Vehicle ..................... 322 Supplemental Restraint System................................... 9, 21 Servicing ....................................... 32 SRS Indicator.......................... 30, 59 System Components.................... 21 SVC.......................................... 115, 158 Synthetic Oil................................... 298 T Taillights, Changing Bulbs ................................... 308, 309 Taking Care of the Unexpected .. 323 Technical Descriptions DOT Tire Quality Grading ....... 352 Emissions Control Systems...... 357 Oxygenated Fuels...................... 254 State Emissions Testing ........... 360 Three Way Catalytic Converter................................ 359 Tire Labeling.................................. 354 Temperature Gauge ........................ 66 Tether Anchorage Points ............... 46 Theft Protection............................. 209 Three Way Catalytic Converter... 359 Time, Setting the ........................... 212 Tire Chains ..................................... 320 Tire, How to Change a Flat .......... 325 Tire Information ............................ 352 Tires ................................................ 315 Air Pressure ............................... 316 Checking Wear .......................... 317 Compact Spare ........................... 324 DOT Tire Quality Grading ....... 352 Inflation....................................... 315 Inspection ................................... 317 Maintenance............................... 318 Replacing .................................... 318 Rotating....................................... 318 Service Life................................. 317 Snow ............................................ 319 Specifications ............................. 351 Tire Chains................................. 320 Tools, Tire Changing .................... 325 Towing A Trailer...................................... 281 Emergency Towing ................... 345 Traction Devices............................ 320 CONTINUED VII INDEX Index Transmission Checking Fluid Level, Automatic ............................... 303 Fluid Selection ................... 303, 304 Identification Number............... 388 Shifting the Automatic.............. 273 Treadwear ...................................... 352 Trip Meter ........................................ 67 Trunk................................................. 88 Opening......................................... 88 Open Monitor Light .................... 60 Turn Signals ..................................... 74 U Vehicle Capacity Load .................. 265 Vehicle Dimensions....................... 350 Vehicle Identification Number..... 349 Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA ) System..................................... 285 VSA Activation Indicator .... 64, 285 VSA Off Switch .......................... 286 VSA System Indicator ......... 64, 285 Vehicle Storage.............................. 322 Ventilation ...................................... 106 VIN .................................................. 348 Viscosity, Oil................................... 297 W Compact Spare ........................... 324 Nut Wrench................................ 325 Windows Operating the Power ................... 97 Rear, Defogger ............................ 76 Windshield Cleaning ........................................ 73 Defroster .................................... 108 Washers ........................................ 73 Wipers, Windshield Changing Blades........................ 312 Operation ...................................... 73 Worn Tires ..................................... 317 Wrecker, Emergency Towing...... 345 Unexpected, Taking Care of the ........................................... 323 Uniform Tire Quality Grading ..... 362 Unleaded Gasoline......................... 254 USB Adapter Cable ....................... 185 USB Flash Memory Device.. 142, 196 Used Oil, How to Dispose of ........ 299 V Vanity Mirror ................................. 100 WARNING, Explanation of ............. iii Warning Labels, Location of .......... 53 Warranty Coverages ..................... 365 Washer, Windshield Checking the Fluid Level ......... 302 Indicator........................................ 61 Operation ...................................... 73 Wheels Adjusting the Steering ................ 77 Alignment and Balance............. 318 Cleaning ...................................... 320 VIII Service Information Summary Gasoline: Unleaded gasoline, pump octane number of 87 or higher. Fuel Tank Capacity: 12.3 US gal (46.6 ) Recommended Engine Oil: API Premium grade 0W-20 detergent oil (see page 215 ). Oil change capacity (including filter): 3.4 US qt (3.2 ) Automatic Transmission Fluid (CVT): Use Honda CVT Fluid (Continuously Variable Transmission Fluid) only Fluid change capacity: 3.0 US qt (2.8 ) Brake Fluid: Honda Heavy Duty Brake Fluid DOT 3 preferred, or a DOT 3 or DOT 4 brake fluid as a temporary replacement (see page 304 ). Tire Pressure (measured cold): Front/Rear: 32 psi (220 kPa , 2.2 kgf/cm ) Spare Tire: 60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm )Acrobat Distiller 6.0.1 (Windows)